Shopsmith 11" Specifications

Shopsmith Upgrades help you keep your prized tools operating
at peak efficiency and in tune with the times
Our Shopsmith engineers are constantly developing new tools and
accessories – as well as special upgrades to help you get more out of
your current Shopsmith tools. The chart below introduces you to the first
of these upgrades – those or the MARK V – which are covered in more
detail on pages 4 - 7. There are dozens of others within these pages.
Just follow the index below or look for our Upgrade Symbol.
You’ll find the Upgrades you need here:
Look For This Special Upgrade Graphic
This catalog contains a number of
upgrades for everything – from several
important MARK V functions – to our
Bandsaw, Jointer, Belt Sander, Planer,
Scroll Saw and Dust Collector.
Pages
Look for this symbol throughout the catalog. It leads the
way to Upgrades that will help you bring your Shopsmith
Tools and Accessories up to today’s high standards.
MARK V .....................4-7
Bandsaw..................8-11
Scroll Saw .............12-14
Belt Sander............15-16
Jointer....................17-18
Strip Sander ..........19-20
Pages
Planer ....................21-22
Dust Collector ......23-25
Miter Gauge................ 36
Shaper/Router ............ 69
Disc Sander ................ 71
Lathe........................... 80
MARK V Model
Table System
Differences
MARK V’s
Anniversary MARK V’s
MARK V’s
MARK V’s
FEATURES
Made before 1990
Main Work Table
Size (without Extension Tables):
Surface:
Miter Gauge slots:
Accept T-Nut-mounted fixtures
14˝w x 18 3/8˝d
Smooth
(2) straight slots
NO
17 1/2˝w x 22˝d
Ribbed for less friction
(2) T-Slots
YES
17 1/2˝w x 22˝d
Ribbed for less friction
(2) T-Slots
YES
17 1/2˝w x 22˝d
Ribbed for less friction
(2) T-Slots
YES
(1) 18 3/8˝ x 4˝
NA
(1) 22˝ x 7 3/8˝
NA
(1) 22˝ x 7 3/8˝
(2) 22˝ x 7 3/8˝
(1) 22˝ x 7 3/8˝
(2) 22˝ x 7 3/8˝
56˝w x 18 3/8˝d
62˝w x 22˝d
62˝w x 22˝d
62˝w x 22˝d
102˝w x 22˝d
102˝w x 22˝d
Extension Tables (Rigid)
(Floating)
Maximum Support Surface Size
End-to-end with one rigid-mount
Extension Table:
End-to-end with one rigid & one floating
Extension Table:
with Model 505 Table System with Model 510 Table System with Model 520 Table System
NA
Maximum Ripping Capacity
48˝
50˝
98˝
98˝
Telescoping Floating Extension Table
Support Legs
NA
NA
(2) Twist-Lock
(2) Twist-Lock
Extension Table Connector Tubes
NA
NA
(4) 27˝ *
(4) 27˝ *
Single in front
NO
NO
Dual, front & rear
YES
YES
Dual, front & rear
YES
YES
Dual, front & rear
YES
YES
Rip Fence
Direct-Reading Scales
Locking
Top T-Slots
Face T-Slots
22˝L x 2 1/8˝h x 1 3/8˝
NO
Single Knob Lock
NA
NA
251/2˝L x 2 3/8˝h x 1 3/8˝
NO
Knob + Lever
One
NA
251/2˝L x 2 3/8˝ h x 1 3/8˝
NO
Knob + Lever
One
NA
241/2˝L x 2 3/4˝ h x 2 1/2˝
YES See Page 7
(2) Quick-Acting Levers
Two
One in each Face
Miter Gauge Bar
(with or without T-Slot Washer)
No T-Slot Washer
T-Slot Washer
T-Slot Washer
T-Slot Washer
NO
YES
YES
YES
NO
YES
YES
YES
NO
YES
YES
YES
Single position with round
Rest Post & Setscrew
adjustment
Dual position with
anti-rotation Rest
Post & Lever-style
Adjustment Handles
Dual position with
anti-rotation Rest
Post & Lever-style
Adjustment Handles
Dual position with
anti-rotation Rest Post &
Lever-style Adjustment
Handles
Table Tilt Mechanism & Carriage
Table Tilt Lock(s)
Wide Table Tube stance
Quarter-turn Carriage Lock & Table-raising
Wheel
Disc Sanding through Table Insert
Guards
See-Through Upper Saw Guard with
Riving Knife
Lower Guard with Sanding Disc Dust
Collection
Lathe Tool Rest
* Optional 5-foot Connector Tubes are available for a significant increase in ripping capacity and improved support for large workpieces.
See Page 30
1-800-543-7586
MARK V Upgrades
3
MARK V Model 500 to 520 Pro Fence & Table Systems Upgrade
State-of-the-art features and capabilities deliver improved working convenience, precision and operator safety
See the Table on Pg. 3 for a comparison of
MARK V Model Features and Specifications
Your upgrade starts with an expanded table
system that includes a larger Work Table and
Extension Table with two Floating Support Tables
and a pair of Telescoping Support Legs. Put it all
together and you’ll have over 8˝ of table width
for crosscutting even the longest boards!
To this, it adds the heavy-duty,
factory-aligned Shopsmith
Pro Fence with four T-Slots ...
two on the top and one on each
face ... for attaching jigs, fixtures
Go from
and aids such as our:
this ...
• Rip Fence-Mount
Featherboard, 555783 - Pg. 29
• T-Track Utility Light Kit, 555806 - Pg. 76
• Flip-Up Rip Fence Stop, 555808 - Pg. 76
... or any shop-made jig or fixture you might
build that mounts to the Fence sides or top
using our Sliding T-Nuts, 514491 - Pg. 36
Here’s what you get with the Pro
Fence and Table System Upgrade Kit:
• Larger Table with big 171/2˝ x 22˝ work
surface. More
support for ripping
4˝ x 8˝ plywood
sheets and crosscutting even the
longest boards.
• Pro Fence is 24 1/2˝ long by 2 1/2˝ thick with
a double T-Slot track on the top surface plus
another T-Slot on each side for attaching
accessories, jigs and fixtures. Two Levers
lock it rigidly to the front and rear of the
Main or Extension Table with a quick flip.
It also includes a wider Fence Straddler.
• New Table
Carriage with
dual Tilt Locks
at the front and
rear of the Table
and a widened
tube stance for added stability. Quarter-turn
Hand Wheel and Lock move the table up and
down – then secure it where you want it.
• Direct-Reading Rip Fence Scales let you read
and instantly set the width of rip cuts up to
38 1/2˝ wide. Includes two interchangeable
stainless steel Scales that are graduated in
both 1/16˝ and 1/32˝ increments.
... to this!
Pre-December, 2004
Model 520 Owners
Add the New
Direct-Reading scales
to your MARK V –
see Page 7
• Two Floating Extension Tables slide on
Connecting Tubes
and lock anywhere between
the Main Table
and the end
Extension Table.
• Four 27˝ Connecting Tubes slip through
the Rails and tie the System together with
locking Knobs.
• Two Telescoping Legs give added
support in the middle or at the ends
of the Connecting Tubes. A quick twist
locks their height.
• See-Through Upper Saw Guard with etchedin depth-of-cut
indicators,
European-style
Riving Knife
and AntiKickback Device.
• New Lower Saw
Guard, updated to
accommodate Shopsmith’s 12˝ Sanding
Disc. Includes 2 1/2˝ diameter dust
collection port.
PLUS ... You’ll also get:
• A new, Two-position Lathe Tool Rest Arm
with lever-style Adjustment Screws.
• An anti-rotation Tool Rest Post.
• A new Saw Table Insert.
• New steel Miter Gauge Bar with T-Slot
Washer.
• Larger Extension Table Top (does not include
vertical mounting tubes).
• A Special Sanding Disc Hub lets you use
your old style steel Disc with the Lower
Saw Guard.
• A new Pro Fence System 11/4˝ diameter
Saw Arbor.
• All required fittings and hardware.
• Instruction Manual, fully describing
alignment, maintenance, safety, tips
and techniques.
• (2) Set-Up and Alignment Gauges.
555985 Pro Fence & Table
$1,321.68
System Upgrade
Important Note: Due to the increased size of the
Pro Fence System Work Table and how various
accessories connect to it, some earlier Model 500
accessories may not fit the Pro Fence upgrade. These
include (but are not limited to) all Table Inserts, Front
Table Extension, Rip Fence, Mortising Hold-Downs and
some Saw Arbors.
The Shopsmith Model 520 Table System Upgrade
is a Special Truck Shipment item
and requires an additional $25 shipping fee.
Please call Tech Support TOLL-FREE at
1-800-762-7555 for more details.
See the bottom of Pg. 5 for more information
4
MARK V Upgrades
www.shopsmith.com
MARK V Model 500 to Model 510 Table System Upgrade
Enjoy improved workpiece support and control with this Model 510 Upgrade Package for older Model 500 MARK V's
If you own a MARK V Model 500 and have been
wanting a larger, more expandable Table and
Fence System for added support and precision
when working with large stock – yet have little
use for the jigging and fixturing capabilities
of our Model 510 Table System – this is the
Upgrade for you.
As with the Pro Fence System Upgrade on
Page 4, you’ll have over 8˝ of table width for
handling even the longest boards! That’s almost
twice the 56˝ your Model 500 machine offers!
Inside the Model 510 Table System
Upgrade Kit:
• Larger Table with
big 17 1/2˝ x 22˝ work
surface. More support
for ripping large sheets
and crosscutting long boards.
• Larger Rip Fence is 24 1/2˝ long x 1 3/8˝ thick
with a single T-Slot track on the top surface
for mounting accessories such as:
– Rip Fence-Mount Featherboard,
555783 - Pg. 29
– T-Track Utility Light Kit, 555806 - Pg. 76
– Flip-Up Rip Fence Stop, 555807 - Pg. 76
A large Butterfly Handle locks the infeed end
while a single Lever locks the outfeed end
with a quick flip.
• New Table Carriage with
dual Tilt Locks at the
front and rear and a
widened tube stance for
added stability. Quarterturn Hand Wheel and
Lock move the table up and down – then
secure it where you want it.
See the Table on Pg. 3 for a comparison of
MARK V Model Features and Specifications
Go from this ...
• Two Floating Extension Tables
slide on Tubes and lock anywhere
between the Main
Table and the
end Extension
Table.
• Four 27˝
Connecting
Tubes go through the Rails and tie the
System together with locking Knobs.
• Two Telescoping Legs give added support in
the middle or at the ends of the Connecting
Tubes. A quick twist locks their height.
• See-Through Upper
Saw Guard with etchedin depth-of-cut indicators,
Anti-Kickback Device
and Riving Knife.
• New Lower Saw Guard, updated to
accommodate Shopsmith’s 12˝ Sanding
Disc. Includes 2 1/2˝ dust port.
PLUS ... You’ll also get:
• A new Two-position Lathe Tool Rest Arm
... to this!
with lever-style Adjustment Screws
and anti-rotation Post.
• A new Saw Table Insert.
• Larger Extension Table Top (does not
include vertical mounting tubes).
• New steel Miter Gauge Bar with T-Slot Washer.
• A Special Sanding Disc Hub lets you use your
old style steel Disc with the Lower
Saw Guard.
• A new Pro Fence System 1 1/4˝ dia. Saw Arbor.
• All required fittings and hardware.
• Instruction Manual, fully describing
alignment, maintenance, safety, tips
and techniques.
555142 Table System
$1,196.89
Retro-Fit Kit
Important Note: Due to the increased size of the
Model 510 Work Table and how various accessories
connect to it, some earlier Model 500 accessories may
not fit the Model 510 upgrade. These include (but are
not limited to) all Table Inserts, Front Table Extension,
Rip Fence, Mortising Hold-Downs and some Saw Arbors.
The Shopsmith Model 510 Table System Upgrade
is a Special Truck Shipment item and requires
an additional $20 shipping fee.
MARK V Model 510 to 520 Pro Fence & Table Systems Upgrade
Add Direct-Reading Rip Fence Scales and a more versatile Rip Fence to your MARK V with the Model 510 Table System
Inside the Model 520 Table System Upgrade Kit:
The Model 520 Table System Upgrade has
been engineered to give you even better precision, control and quality performance than you’ve
come to expect from your MARK V with the
Model 510 Table System. The professional-duty
Fence features two interchangeable stainless
steel Scales for direct-reading of rip cut widths
... plus ... twin locking Levers ... one for the
infeed end of the Fence and another for the
outfeed end to ensure a positive, precise fence
lock-down, even when working with large and/
or heavy workpieces. It drops straight down onto
the fence rails without tipping or fiddling, then
slides along the Rails on high-tech glides.
1-800-543-7586
• Larger Rip Fence is 241/2˝ long x 21/2˝ thick
with dual T-Slot Tracks on the top surface and
a T-Slot Track on each Face for mounting
accessories such as:
– Rip Fence-Mount Featherboard,
555783 - Pg. 29
– T-Track Utility Light Kit, 555806 - Pg. 76
– Flip-Up Rip Fence Stop, 555808 - Pg. 76
• New Direct-Reading Rip Fence Scales let you
set rip cut dimensions in an instant
without measurement. Includes two
magnetic, stainless steel Scales ...
one 45˝ long with a “zero-point” 6 1/2˝
from the left end and 38 1/2˝ from the
right end – and a second scale 16˝ long with
a “zero-point” 6 1/2˝ from the left end and 9 1/2˝
from the right end. See Page 7
• New, wider Fence Straddler.
• (8) New Extruded Rails for Main and
Extension Tables.
• All required fittings and hardware.
• Instruction Manual, fully describing alignment,
maintenance, safety, tips and techniques.
• (2) Set-Up and Alignment Gauges.
510 to 520
Pro Fence System
555982 For Model 510 MARK V's
or Upgrades – 1986 or later
$475.69
555983 For Model 510 MARK V's
purchased or upgraded
prior to 1986
$475.69
MARK V Upgrades
5
Anniversary / Model 505
to Model 520 Upgrade
MARK V Model 500 Upgrades
B. For older model MARK V’s with aluminum
Enjoy increased workpiece support
and precision with the Pro Fence
System Table Upgrade Kit
Upper and Lower Saw Guards
This is the Upgrade you want if you have
aluminum Upper and Lower Saw Guards
with a 2 1/4˝ dust port. You’ll get the Dual Port
Lower Guard plus the See-Through Upper
Guard with anti-kickback Fingers. Some drilling and tie bar modifications required.
505875 Model 500 Clear
$227.87
Saw Guard System
The Model 520 Table System Upgrade gives you
everything you need to step your Anniversary
MARK V with Model 505 Table System up to
the super-versatile workpiece support system
and enhanced Rip Fence of MARK Vs with the
Model 520 Table System.
You’ll get the professional-duty Pro Fence with
Direct-Reading Scales, two Floating Extension
Tables, plus Connector Tubes and Telescoping
Legs to tie it all together into a System that will
deliver optimum workpiece support.
Here’s what you get with the Model 520
Table System Upgrade Kit:
• Larger Rip Fence is 24 1/2˝ long x 21/2˝ thick
with dual T-Slot Tracks on the top surface
and a T-Slot Track on each Face.
• (2) New Direct-Reading Rip Fence Scales.
You get two magnetic,
stainless steel Scales, one 45˝
long and one 16˝ long. Bottom Page 5
• New, wider Fence Straddler.
• (8) New Rails for Main and Extension Tables.
• Two Floating Extension Tables slide on
Connecting Tubes and lock anywhere you
want them.
• Four 27˝ Connecting Tubes slip through
the Rails and tie the System together with
locking Knobs.
• Two Telescoping Legs give added support.
A quick twist locks their height.
• All required fittings and hardware.
• Instruction Manual.
• (2) special Set-Up and Alignment Gauges.
555986 Model 505 Pro Fence
$691.67
& Table Upgrade
Model 510 Extension Table Upgrade
for Anniversary MARK V’s with
Model 505 Table System
Add the (2) Floating Tables, (4) Connector Tubes
and (2) Telescoping Legs and (2) T-Joint Leg
Fittings to upgrade your Anniversary MARK V
with Model 505 Table System to the Model 510
Table System
555137 Model 510 Extension
$289.14
Table Upgrade
6
MARK V Upgrades
Rip Fence Upgrade for Model 500
MARK V's offers T-Slot top surface
and single Lever locking mechanism
C
The convenient T-Slot on the Fence’s top
surface accepts our:
• Rip Fence-Mount Featherboard,
555783 - Pg. 29
• Flip-Up Rip Fence Stop, 555808 - Pg. 76
• T-Track Utility Light Bracket
521787 - Pg. 76
• or shop-made fixtures using our
Sliding T-Nuts, 514491 - Pg. 36
The single, flip-up Lever locks both the front
and the back firmly to the Work Table in one
simple action. Also works with the original
as well as the wider (555084 or 555085)
Model 500 Extension Table.
$117.20
555646 Rip Fence
C. For older model MARK V’s with Poly-V-Belt
Drive System
Earlier Model 500 MARK V’s were
produced with a single bearing Quill
that could generate runout and wobble
that will jeopardize the precision of your drilling, turning and other operations. This dual
bearing Quill will solve that problem
and improve your results on virtually every
project. Installs easily, in less than an hour,
by following the detailed instructions.
555088 Model 500 Two-Bearing
$127.69
Quill Upgrade
A
B
D
D. 7 1/2˝ wide Model 500 Extension Table is
Two upgrades bring added dust
collection efficiency and safety to
your MARK V
A. Lower Saw Guard Upgrade for MARK V’s
with serial numbers below 222396
This is the Upgrade you want if you have a
plastic Lower Saw Guard with a 1 1/4˝ dust
collection port. Provides dual 2 1/4˝ ports
for more efficient dust collection. Some
drilling and tie bar modifications required.
$55.90
555294 Lower Saw Guard
Upgrade
nearly double the width of original Tables!
Increases Table size from 41/4˝ wide to
7 1/2˝ wide, providing added support for
many operations and up to 4 3/4˝ of
on-table Rip Fence adjustment. Offset
mounting extends ripping capacity even
further. Order as a complete Table with
Down Tubes – or save and order as a
Top-Only version that can be mounted
to your existing Model 500 Down Tubes.
555084 Model 500 Extension
$142.88
Table Upgrade
555085 Model 500 Extension
$79.56
Table (Top Only)
www.shopsmith.com
Model 520 Rip Scale Upgrade Kit
Set Rip Cut dimensions with lightning
speed and precision
Install this Rip Scale Upgrade Kit and in about a
half-hour, and you’ll be instantly setting rip cut
dimensions quickly and precisely.
A powerful magnetic strip attached to the top
of each Rail holds your choice of a short or long
precision stainless steel Scale that’s graduated
in both, 32nds and 16ths.
Choose
the long
Scale when
making
cuts from
6 1/2˝ to the
left of the
blade to
38 1/2˝ to
the right* or the short Scale when making
cuts from 6 1/2˝ to the left of the blade
to 9 1/2˝ to the right.
Zeroing adjustments are easily made by
simply re-positioning the steel Scales on their
magnetic holders. Once positioned, they will
remain where you put them without shifting.
The Kit includes a new 17 1/2˝ Front Rail for
your Main Table, (3) 71/2˝ Front Rails for your
Extension Tables, a 16˝ long steel Scale, a
45˝ long steel Scale, a wide, easy-to-read Scale
Indicator plus complete instructions
and all required installation hardware.
522292 Complete Rip Scale Kit
$199.87
(for Model 520 Pro Fence
MARK V's only)
$49.30
$26.05
522269 38˝ Scale
522270 91/2˝ Scale
* Scales will also read in opposite direction,
except numbers will be upside-down.
Take the work out of the toughest woodworking operations
with Shopsmith’s versatile Special Purpose Tools
Jointer
Bandsaw
Scroll Saw
Only Shopsmith packs full functionality into a limited amount of space
Shopsmith’s Special Purpose Tools are the only
full-sized stationary tools that you can pack five
of into a tight corner of your garage or basement.
That’s possible because they all use the
MARK V as both their operating stand – and
– their rugged, 11/8 hp, variable-speed power
source! This means you won’t have to try and
cram a bunch of bulky, stand-mounted tools with
separate motors and bases into your limited space.
When needed, simply retrieve them from their
storage space, slip their twin Mounting Tubes
into your MARK V’s Headrest, attach the slip-on
Power Coupler and go to work.
Belt Sander
Strip Sander
a
table
saw
or
circular
saw,
it’s also often the
Special Tools for Special Purposes
best
choice
for
cutting
stock
up to 6˝ thick.
Although many woodworking operations may be possible with hand tools
The Scroll Saw – will amaze you with its
or portable electrics, they’re usually
extremely intricate, internal or external cuts
faster, easier and far more precise when (straight or curved) in stock up to 2˝ thick.
you use stationary, Special Purpose
This is a prime evolutionary example of what
Tools, designed specifically for the job. we used to call “jigsaws” – just far superior!
The term Special Purpose Tools,
The Thickness Planer – will significantly
more often than not, is somewhat of a
improve
the fit of your project components
misnomer, since many of these tools
(and therefore, the quality of your projects)
are quite versatile and capable of performing a
by seeing to it that every piece of stock you
number of different, important functions.
Power
use is of a consistent thickness.
Here are their primary purposes:
Station &
The Belt Sander – is an amazing work-saver
Tool Stands The Jointer – is a “must-have” tool if you’re
that
will provide precisely-adjustable back-up
planning to build cabinets or furniture. Its
See Page - 26
support
while it quickly sands down or smooths
purpose is to plane the edges of boards so
stock up to 6˝ wide. It makes easy work of
smoothly that you can join them together
woodworking’s most tedious task.
into wide panels without unsightly glue lines.
Stand-Mount option
If you’re planning to use a certain Tool frequently, The Bandsaw – cuts tight or sweeping curves
The Strip Sander – is an often overlooked machine
you can also buy it with its own Power Stand
with matchless speed and precision. And, since that’s great for all types of intricate sanding and
grinding tasks ... as well as sharpening.
(including motor) – or add the Power Stand later. it offers a more generous depth-of-cut than
1-800-543-7586
Thickness Planer
Special Purpose Tools
7
The Shopsmith 11˝ Bandsaw – Easily makes straight or curved
cuts in wood (up to 6˝ thick) plastics and non-ferrous metals
Loaded With Work-Saving, ResultsEnhancing Benefits and Accessories
As with all Shopsmith Special Purpose Tools, your
Bandsaw offers a number of great features and
accessories helping make everything you make – better.
MARK V or Stand Mount
Every Shopsmith Special Purpose Tool offers you the
option of mounting and powering it with your Shopsmith
MARK V – or with its own individual, motorized Stand.
Large, Versatile Table
The Bandsaw brings so many unique, work-saving capabilities to the shop
that it’s easy to see why it consistently rates as our most popular Special
Purpose Tool.
13 1/2˝ x 151/2˝
Power Stand Information – See Page 26
large for plenty of
support, with an easy-to-read scale
for accurate tilt adjustments from
5° left to 45° right ... and a special
T-Slot extrusion that you can fine-tune
to fit your Miter Gauge precisely for
smooth, wobble-free operation
and enhanced precision.
Unlimited Cut-Off Capacity on
What you’ll do with your new Shopsmith Bandsaw
Workpieces up to 3 7/8˝ Wide
Although Bandsaws were originally developed to make curved cuts, it
Exclusive Reversible Blade Guides allow you to
didn’t take long before users realized that it offered a number of great,
twist the Blade to a 30° angle from the Saw’s
straight-line cutting advantages, as well. For example, not many Table
frame, so you can achieve this unusual capability.
Saws (commercial or otherwise) will cut stock up to 6˝ thick ... or cut
metal. Here are a few of the jobs your Shopsmith Bandsaw is well-suited
Easy Blade Tension Adjustments
to tackle:
It’s as simple as matching the indicator on the
CUT TIGHT OR SWEEPING CURVES – No home shop saw will cut faster than
Tension Gauge with the blade width you’re using,
a Bandsaw ... and with Shopsmith’s generous-sized support table and full
and you don’t even have to remove the Cover!
range of 1/16˝ to 5/8˝ wide Blades, you’ll have just what you need to cut
A Full Range of Hard-Working Accessories
simple or intricate curves in wood, plastic and non-ferrous metals.
When you need accessories to help you
MAKE COMPOUND CUTS TO CREATE 3-D OBJECTS
perform specialized operations with your
Curved table legs are often created by first cutting
Shopsmith Bandsaw, we’ve got them. From
the required curves on the two opposing faces of a
a versatile Rip Fence to a Table Extension,
board – taping the scrap back into position – then
Circle Cutter, special Cool Blocks and a full
rotating the board 90° and repeating the process.
complement of Blades to make all types of
QUICKLY CUT WOODS UP TO 6˝ THICK – Whether
See Pages 9 - 11 cuts in a variety of materials.
straight or curved, the Bandsaw is your best choice
for cutting thick woods other saws just can’t handle.
555943 Shopsmith 11˝ Bandsaw
$544.99
Includes Instruction Manual and 1/4 ˝ Combination
RESAW THIN BOARDS FROM THICK ONES –
Blade (555419). Power Coupler required for use with
Sometimes, you need wood that’s thinner than the “standards” for special
Shopsmith MARK V, Power Stand or Power Station.
projects. Armed with a Bandsaw and a 1/2 ˝ or 5/8˝ Resawing Blade, you
can stand boards up to 6˝ wide on edge and “slice” thick boards into thinPower Coupler
ner ones, just like the lumberyards.
required for use with
PAD-SAW MULTIPLE ITEMS SIMULTANEOUSLY – Need four identical
Shopsmith MARK V or
Power Station
bracket feet for a small clock or box? Use Double-Stick Tape to create
a stack of boards of identical thicknesses (up to 6˝ total) and saw them
See Page - 26
all at once, then separate.
CUT METALS, PLASTICS & OTHER MATERIALS – When making straight or
The Shopsmith Bandsaw is a Special Truck Shipment item
curved cuts in non-ferrous metals (up to 1/4˝ thick), plastics, rubber and
and requires an additional $25 shipping fee.
other materials, no other home shop Saw will out-perform the Bandsaw.
Specifications
Cutoff capacity
(Blade in normal position) .........................101/2"
Cutoff capacity (Blade offset – limited
to 3 7/8" wide stock)............................. Unlimited
Max. depth of cut ............................................. 6"
Table size ...................................... 131/2" x 151/2"
8
Table tilt ..................................5° left to 45° right
Table Auto-Stop ......................................... at “0”
Bearings ...........Sealed ball, roller & needle style
Speed (recommended) .............700 to 1,050 rpm
Accepts Blades ............................. 1/16"* to 5/8"
Blade tensioning .................Set to built-in Scale
adjustment
Blade tracking ..................................... Automatic
Weight .......................................................45 lbs.
*NOTE: 1/16" Blades require optional Cool Blocks
Shopsmith 11" Bandsaw
www.shopsmith.com
Adjust Bandsaw Blade
tension instantly with
out removing the Cover
C
A
Urethane Bandsaw Tires
install without glue,
improve tracking
performance and outlast
conventional rubber tires
B
Three-piece Accessory Package
helps you get the most out of your
Shopsmith Bandsaw
A. Bandsaw Fence delivers improved straight-line
cutting results
Self-aligning aluminum fence locks firmly into position on the
Bandsaw Table with a twist of the Handle and a fiip of the Locking
Lever. Adjusts from “0” to 5" from Blade. Accepts Fence mounted
accessories such as Flip-Up Stop, T-Track mounted Utility Light and
Featherboards. For use on Shopsmith Bandsaws with aluminum
See Pages 29 & 32
tables only (shown here).
555645 Bandsaw Fence
$95.86
B. Table Extension adds 111/2" of outboard Bandsaw Table
support for improved workpiece control and precision
Slides into the twin Mounting Holes in the edge of your aluminum
(only) Shopsmith Bandsaw Table to provide loads of extra support,
as well as a Mounting Platform for the Bandsaw Circle Cutter (C)
listed below.
The new Shopsmith Bandsaw
Cover allows you to see when
adjusting your blade tension
without ever having to remove the
cover! It also has an arrow to
take the guess work out of which
way your blade should run. The
Shopsmith logo is in the mold, so
there’s no sticker to get scratched.
522221 Bandsaw
$61.27
Cover
Protect your Bandsaw with
a custom-fitted Dust Cover
Just attach to the Bandsaw Extension
Table (B. above) and pivot your workpiece from above or below the table
as you cut perfect circles from 2"
to 36" in diameter. Requires
Extension (555488)
This rugged,
cotton/ polyester Cover is
custom-sewn
to the shape of
your Shopsmith
Bandsaw. The
special urethane coating repels
moisture while a unique perforation
process allows any moisture that
might get in from below to escape,
preventing rust and corrosion.
555489 Bandsaw Circle Cutter
517000 Bandsaw
$25.77
555488 Bandsaw Table Extension
C. Circle Cutter helps you create perfectly round circles
in a fiash with your Bandsaw
555668 Complete Bandsaw
Accessory Pkg. (Includes A, B & C above)
$36.24
$133.98
YOU SAVE $18.00
Cool Blocks‚ extend Blade life
Cool Block Blade Guides are made of a special, nonmetallic material that lubricates your Bandsaw Blades
as they cut, keeping them cool and reducing the
chance of premature breakage. And, since they won’t
damage Blade teeth, you can really snug them down
for added stability when working with smaller blades.
Required if you’re using our 3/32" Blade (556261).
$19.24
555374 Cool Blocks Blade Guides
5556262Kit, including Cool Blocks
$41.48
and 3/32" Blade (556261)
YOU SAVE $4.61
1-800-543-7586
$23.57
Dust Cover
Eccentric Tubes let you
raise your MARK V to
vertical while Bandsaw
is mounted on end
Designed to offset your Bandsaw
in the MARK V Mounting Tubes
just enough to allow you to raise
the MARK V to Drill Press position without having to remove the
Bandsaw from its Mount.
555626 Bandsaw
$40.44
Eccentric Tubes
These bright orange Tires have
been manufactured to our exacting specifications for use with the
Shopsmith Bandsaw. Made from
a special urethane compound,
they will improve blade tracking
(especially with smaller blades)...
repel sawdust build-up... and
provide added durability over our
standard
rubber tires.
To install, submerge in hot
(125° – not boiling ) water for
about 15 minutes to soften
them... and stretch them onto
your Bandsaw wheels. No glue is
required.
The “welds” on these Tires are
guaranteed for life. If they should
fail, simply return them to the
manufacturer for a replacement.
Includes two Tires.
522458 Urethane
$35.99
Bandsaw
Tires
Make your Blades last
longer by occasionally
replacing the Tires
on your Bandsaw
Eliminate vibrations and ensure
proper Blade tracking. Includes
instructions.
555644 Bandsaw
$19.99
Tire/Adhesive Kit
518108 Bandsaw
$11.99
Tire (only)
Bandsaw Accessories
9
A full range of Shopsmith Bandsaw Blades to meet
your most exacting requirements
Choose Standard or Premium Blades, based on your service and budget needs
Whether you’re cutting large sweeping curves; straight lines; tight, intricate
fretwork; resawing thin boards from thick ones; or working with a variety of
materials from non-ferrous metals through the softest of woods...Shopsmith
has a Bandsaw Blade to do the job.
Both grades of Blades are made specifically for your Shopsmith Bandsaw
from premium-quality, silicon carbon steel. All Blades (except 555386)
have precision milled teeth for added sharpness and consistency of cut,
compared to stamped-tooth Blades.
Approx.
Actual Size
Part
No.
N/A
555632
1/16˝
1/4˝
Style
Teeth
Tooth
Quality Per Inch Config.
Combo
Std.
Combo
Std.
24
6
Raker
Min.
Materials
Wood, plastics
up to 1˝ thick
Hooked
Wood, plastics,
plywood, soft
non-ferrous
metals
Radius
Comments
3/16˝
For super-smooth, fine
cuts. Requires Cool
Blocks (555374) for use
3/4˝
See Page 9
Great, all-purpose Blade.
Deep gullets and
positive rake for fast
chip removal and fine cut
Price
N/A
$16.16
3/4˝
3-tooth set sequence
(left-right-straight) for
fine finish cuts. Excellent
metal-cutter
$16.16
555633
1/4˝
Combo
Std.
14
Raker
Wood, plastics,
non-ferrous
metals
555196
1/2˝
Combo
Std.
6
Raker
Wood, plywood,
non-ferrous
metals
2˝
For woods up to 3˝ thick
and metal work on stock
up to 1/2˝ thick
$16.16
555421
5/8˝
Wood
Std.
3-4
Variable
Wood
NA
Strictly for resawing
and straight-line cutting.
Use 1/2˝ tension setting on
Shopsmith Bandsaw
$16.16
555419
1/4˝
Combo.
Std.
6
Hooked
Wood, plastics,
plywood, soft
non-ferrous
metals
3/4˝
Standard with all
Shopsmith Bandsaws
.025˝ thick
$16.16
1/4˝
Combo.
Std.
Hooked
Wood, plastics,
plywood, soft
non-ferrous
metal
3/4˝
Finer teeth than 555419
for finer cuts
$16.16
521984
1/8˝
Combo
Premium
14
Raker
Wood, plastics,
plywood, soft
non-ferrous
metals
1/4˝
Require Cool Blocks
(555374) for use
See Page 9
.025˝ thick
$28.97
521985
3/16˝
Combo.
Premium
10
Raker
Wood, plastics,
plywood, soft
non-ferrous
metals
3/8˝
.025˝ thick
$28.97
1/2˝
.025˝ thick
$28.97
2˝
Aggressive-cutting 9°
to 11° Rake Angle
.025˝ thick
$28.97
555420
10
Size
If a Shopsmith
Blade breaks at Lifetime Guarantee On Weld Integrity
the weld, we’ll
replace it...FREE! Premium Blades are induction heat-treated to ensure an
even hardness, and feature a special tooth set and rake angle to provide
more aggressive cutting with less pressure. This reduces heat built-up,
prolonging Blade life substantially.
14
521986
1/4˝
Combo.
Premium
10
Raker
Wood, plastics,
plywood, soft
non-ferrous
metals
521987
1/2˝
Wood
Premium
4
Hooked
Wood or plywood
up to 6˝ thick
Bandsaw Accessories
www.shopsmith.com
Get added precision and control with
the Kreg Deluxe Bandsaw Rip Fence
Deluxe Fence increases your Bandsaw’s ripping
capacity and cutting versatility
This Fence System was designed exclusively
for the Shopsmith Bandsaw. The rugged
aluminum rail extrusions attach to the
existing holes in the underside of late
model Shopsmith Bandsaws with selftapping bolts (included). Once attached,
you’ll have a 20˝ long by 2 3/4˝ high
precision rip fence with a direct-reading
scale that locks firmly into position with
a single knob to rip stock up to 9 3/8˝
wide (that’s 43/8˝ wider than our regular
Bandsaw Fence). Its face and top surfaces
both include preformed T-slots to accept
Shopsmith’s Flip Stops, Featherboards,
and Utility Lights – or your choice of special,
shop-made jigs and fixtures.
This Fence can also be laid down and
attached to the mounting head horizontally. The Fence face can also be used with your Premium Bandsaw Fence on the MARK V or other
Shopsmith tools. Note: Not for older model Bandsaws with cast iron worktables.
NEW
Optional Micro-Adjuster clamps into the Fence Rail
T-Slot with a large, comfortable knob. Then, simply loosen
the Fence Mounting Head and rotate the Micro-Adjuster’s
thumbwheel to gradually advance or retrieve the Fence
by 1/20˝ with each full rotation.
Optional Micro-Adjuster
Optional 41/2˝ high Resawing Guide attaches to the
T-Slot in the Rip Fence face. Its gently curved face allows
you to follow a drawn line down the top edge of a board
to be resawed ... compensating for blade lead as you go.
The Pros say, these are the best style Resawing Fences!
Optional 4 1/2 ˝ high Resawing Guide
$93.45
$40.95
$62.95
522460 Mounting Rail & Hardware
556032 Front & Rear Fence Supports
556005 20˝ Premium Bandsaw Fence
556030 Complete Bandsaw Rip Fence System
$183.74
SAVE $13.61
(Includes Mounting Rail & Hardware, Front & Rear
Fence Supports and Premium Bandsaw Fence)
$16.79
$20.53
522511 Bandsaw Fence Micro-Adjuster
522514 Bandsaw Fence Resawing Guide
556031 Deluxe Bandsaw Fence System
(Includes Complete Bandsaw Rip Fence System, Micro-Adjuster & Resawing Guide)
1-800-543-7586
$220.47
Bandsaw Upgrades
Bandsaw Dust Chute eliminates
dust and debris at the source
For earlier model
Bandsaws without
Dust Chutes
Includes all mounting
hardware and instructions.
300000 Retro-Fit Bandsaw
$18.29
Dust Chute
Make your older model Shopsmith
Bandsaw run smoother and quieter
NO MORE SQUEALING!
If the backup rollers on your older model
Shopsmith Bandsaw are worn or driving you
crazy with their incessant squealing, here’s
your solution!
Permanently lubricated Ball Bearing Assemblies
work with 1/16˝ through 5/8˝ Blades to reduce
friction and make your Blades last longer. For
Bandsaws with serial numbers prior to 97932.
Replaces Upper, Lower and Auto-Track BackUp Rollers. Easy to install.
555074 Bandsaw Retro-Fit Kit
$27.71
Step up to the precision and
convenience of Shopsmith’s
current Bandsaw Table System
For earlier model Bandsaws with
cast iron tables
Now, you can enjoy our new, 45% larger
aluminum Bandsaw Table with all its provisions
for our Bandsaw Rip Fence, Table Extension
and Circle Cutter.
See Page 9 Order just the Table now and
add accessories later – or
order the complete Table System and save!
555667 Bandsaw Table System $246.59
(Includes Fence, Extension Table,
Circle Cutter & Table Retro-Fit Kit)
YOU SAVE $22.30
Bigger is better with the Table
Retro-Fit Kit
40% larger, tilts a full 45°, with an adjustable
table insert. Required to use with our Bandsaw
Fence, Table Extension and Table Retro-Fit Kit.
555487 Bandsaw Table
$116.91
Retro-Fit Kit (Table only)
Kreg Bandsaw Fence/Bandsaw Upgrades
11
The Shopsmith 20˝ Scroll Saws – MARK V or Stand-Mount
feature-for-feature, they’re both hands-down Winners!
Loaded With Work-Saving, ResultsEnhancing Benefits and Accessories
As with all Shopsmith Special Purpose Tools, your Scroll Saw offers great
features and accessories to help you make everything you make – better.
MARK V-Mount
Every Shopsmith Special Purpose Tool offers you
the option of mounting and powering it with your
MARK V – or on a motorized Stand.
Parallel Arm Action – Blade moves forward
on the down stroke, back on the up stroke to clear the sawdust and help
you achieve perfect 90° turns and corners every time. (Upper Arm is totally
enclosed for safety.)
Huge 16˝ x 23 1/ 2˝ Table – Provides more than enough support (plus a
full 20˝ of throat depth) for your largest projects. Tilts to 45° in both directions on a direct-reading Quadrant and locks solidly with a simple twist of
a Knob.
The Scroll Saw is one of the safest and easiest to use of all stationary
power tools – and that’s what makes it your best choice for introducing
adults and children alike to “The Joys of Woodworking.”
It’s delicate enough to saw thin veneers or inlays, intricate fretwork
or mother-of-pearl – yet powerful enough to slice through brass, bone,
plastics and hard or soft woods up to a full 2˝ thick with ease and safety.
Its special Blade Blocks hold all 5˝ plain end Fretsaw or Jigsaw Blades
from 1/4 wide down to super-fine Blades for making extremely intricate
cuts. And, where old style Jigsaws only powered their Blades on the down
stroke (making smooth cuts in thick wood almost impossible), Scroll Saws
power their Blades on both the down (cutting) and up (return) stroke.
This constant tension action delivers far more positive control over the
cut and helps prevent premature blade breakage. And, with a little practice,
your cuts will be so smooth you won’t have to do any sanding at all!
What you’ll do with your new Shopsmith Scroll Saw
CREATE ONE-OF-A-KIND CRAFT PROJECTS – From puzzles to jewelry,
to signs to intricate fretwork projects, the Scroll Saw is the saw of choice
for crafts people. It will tackle all types of materials and make super-fine,
super-smooth cuts in all of them.
PERFORM TASKS THAT ARE DIFFICULT FOR OTHER SAWS – Other saws
can’t match the performance of a Scroll Saw for jobs like:
• Making intricate, internal piercing cuts in veneer-thin to 2 thick
woods – plus – metals, plastics, rubber and other materials.
• Creating small, hand-cut-looking dovetails, corner-lap, mortise-andtenon and similar joints.
• Cutting out super-small projects or components that are either
too small or too dangerous to handle on other sawing machinery.
• Coping the inside corners of “off-angle” moldings that may otherwise be difficult to fit.
HAVE SOME GREAT WOODWORKING FUN! – The most frequently reported
problem with Scroll Saws is that they’re so versatile and so much fun to
use that they can often become addictive. You’ll love it!
12
Shopsmith Scroll Saw
Fast, 30-second, tool-less Blade attachment – A quick, quarter-turn of the Blade-locking
Thumb Nuts is all it takes. No tools,
and no fumbling required.
Time-saving dual Blade tensioning controls
Rear, flip-up Lever provides primary tensioning during
Blade changes while up-front Release allows rapid
tensioning when removing and re-inserting blades
through cut-outs during internal piercing cuts.
Clear, see-through Upper Guard – Lets light in,
then flips up and out of the way for quick, tool-free Blade changes.
Hold-Down with Dust Blower – Provides vertical Blade guarding
with a single Knob height adjustment plus a built-in Blower to keep your
cutting line free of dust and debris at all times.
Heavy, zinc alloy Base – Dampens vibrations for super-smooth running.
$699.99
555715 Shopsmith MARK V Mount Scroll Saw
Includes Instruction Manual and one pack of 18 Assorted Blades (518368)
$12.56
555722 Leveling Feet
The Shopsmith Scroll Saw is a Special Truck Shipment item
and requires an additional $25 shipping fee.
Power Coupler
required for use with
Shopsmith MARK V or
Power Station
See Page - 26
www.shopsmith.com
Choose the Shopsmith Scroll Saw Model that
best meets your needs
SPECIFICATIONS
Arm style
Throat capacity
Table size
MARK V
Mount
FreeStanding
Stand-Mounted
Parallel action
Parallel action
Parallel action
20˝
20˝
20˝
Table tilt
Max. depth-of-cut
Length of stroke
(w/555369 Stand)
B
16˝ x 23 /2˝
16˝ x 23 /2˝
16˝ x 23 /2˝
45° left & right
45° left & right
45° left & right
2˝ (wood)
2˝ (wood)
2˝ (wood)
7/8˝
7/8˝
7/8˝
1
1
1
Strokes-per-minute
Variable:
250 - 1450 rpm
Variable:
500 - 1450
Two 4-speed ranges*
HI: 265, 395, 675, 990
LO: 190, 300, 475, 700
Blade type required
5˝ plain end
5˝ plain end
5˝ plain end
Drive type
MARK V Speed Dial
Electron. variable speed
Belt & (2) 4-step pulleys
Motor type
MARK V Headstock
1/8hp, 115V, 60hz
1/2hp, 115V, 60hz
Switch type
MARK V Headstock
Safety toggle, recessed
Safety toggle, recessed
62 lbs.
81 lbs.
81 lbs.
Weight
A
A. Upgrade your older model Shopsmith Scroll
Saw for super-fast Blade changes
For owners of Shopsmith Scroll Saws
with part numbers 555220 or 555272
Now, you’ll be able to disengage and reengage Scroll Saw Blades from the front of
the machine in 10 seconds for super-quick
changes when making multiple internal
piercing cuts – or – to change blades
completely in just 30 seconds!
* Two speed ranges achieved by swapping Tool and Motor Pulleys.
Three ways to order your Shopsmith Scroll Saw
1. If you’ll be using your Scroll Saw often, or
plan to take it to craft shows ... our FreeStanding Model is probably your best choice.
2. If you’re only going to use your Scroll Saw
occasionally ... or have a limited budget ...
our MARK V Mounted Model is probably
best for you.
Make your Free-Standing Shopsmith
Scroll Saw portable with these
Retractable Casters
Scroll Saw Upgrades
3. If you’re not certain but think you may
eventually want a Free-Standing Model ...
you can always start out with a MARK V
Mount Model now, then order a Power
Stand later as your budget permits.
Tensioning will also be easier, thanks to our
new flip-on, flip-off Lever actuated system.
Plus ... you’ll have a much better view of
your workpiece as you look through the
replacement plastic See-Through Hood.
See Page 26 for Power Stand information
Kit includes: See-Through Plastic Hood,
Hold-Down Foot/Guard, Rear Tension Lever,
up-front Quick Tension Release Lever and
Quick Change Blade Block System.
Protect your Scroll Saw with our
custom-fitted Dust Cover
555706 Scroll Saw Blade
$39.82
Change System
Upgrade Kit
B. Update your Scroll Saw’s Blade Block
Two-step Pedals lift your Free-Standing Scroll
Saw up 1/4˝ or 1/2˝ off the ground for each
movement, then settle it down for work.
Includes all mounting hardware. NOTE: These
Casters are only for the Free-Standing Scroll
Saw and will not work with 555369 Stand.
555457 Free-Standing
$96.43
Scroll Saw Casters
1-800-543-7586
Our rugged cotton/polyester Cover is customsewn to the shape of your Shopsmith Scroll Saw
(either MARK V Mount, Free-Standing
or Stand-Mount Model). The special urethane
coating repels moisture while a unique perforation process allows any moisture that might
get in from below to escape, preventing rust
and corrosion.
515308 Scroll Saw Dust Cover
Upgrade Kit
Now, you can quickly install and remove
Scroll Saw Blades from the front of the
machine when making multiple internal
piercing cuts. These new Upper and Lower
Chucks attach directly to the Arms of your
Saw (just like those in the Upgrade Kit
above), and allow you to change Blades without the need for Allen Wrenches or fumbling
with removable Blade Blocks.
Owners of other Model Shopsmith Scroll
Saws who wish to upgrade, should order
the 555706 Kit above.
555708 Scroll Saw Blade
$43.81
Block Upgrade Kit
$23.57
Scroll Saw Accessories
13
Cut blade changing times
down to size with these
momentary foot switches
A full range of Shopsmith Scroll Saw Blades
to meet your most exacting requirements
Assorted Blade Pack gives you 18
of the most universal-sized Ground
Tooth Blades at a nice savings
Blade Profiles
➠
➠
➠
➠
➠
Includes one package each of our three
Ground Tooth Blades (911342, 911343
and 911344). Standard with all Shopsmith
Scroll Saws.
518368 Assorted Scroll Saw
$20.27
Blade Pack
Style
Part
No.
Price
Size
Width
Thickness
Teeth
Per In.
Precision
Ground Tooth
911342
$6.76
5RG
.044˝
.018˝
12 / 9
(6)
REV
$6.76
(6)
7RG
.046˝
.018˝
10 / 7
REV
➤
911344
$6.76
(6)
9RG
.048˝
.018˝
8/6
REV
Skip Tooth
555262
9
.053˝
.018˝
11.5
7
.045˝
.017˝
11.5
5
.038˝
.016˝
12.5
Skip Tooth
Reverse Skip Tooth
Spiral
Metal Cutting
Materials
Comments
Wood, nonferrous metals
and virtually all
materials
Rapid chip removal
w/ minimal burning.
Cut very fast
and smooth.
Best all-around
Perfect for use with Scroll
Saws and other machines.
Tool is only on when your
foot is on the switch. Great
for rapid blade repositioning
when making Scroll Saw
piercing cuts.
13 AMPS – 8-foot Cord, no
Safety Guard.
521666 Unguarded
$37.42
Momentary Switch
“
Best all-around
➤
911343
Precision Ground Tooth
$6.76
(12)
➤
2/0
.022˝
.010˝
28
Reverse
Skip Tooth
555265
$6.76
(12)
—
.100˝
.022˝
9/5
REV
12R
.062˝
.024˝
7R
.047˝
.017˝
5R
.038˝
.016˝
911391
$6.76
(12)
$6.76
(12)
$6.76
(12)
555361
$7.98
(12)
555366
911390
➤
Spiral
555362
911394
$7.98
(12)
$7.98
(12)
46
2
035˝
—
41
4
.041˝
—
36
7
.041˝
.019˝
30
9
.049˝
.022˝
25
12
.070˝
.023˝
20
➤
14
Scroll Saw Accessories
Non-ferrous
metals & hard
materials
Made of hardened,
tempered steel
➤
911393
$7.98
(12)
—
➤
911392
.026˝
Multi-directional,
360° cutting w/o
turning workpiece.
Great for 0° radius
scroll/fretwork
➤
Metal-Cutting
0
Wood, nonferrous metals
and virtually all
materials
➤
➤
555363
$7.98
(12)
$7.98
(12)
9.5 / 6
REV
11.5 / 8
REV
12.5 / 9
REV
Wood, plastics Same as above with
fibrous materials reverse cut bottom
teeth to minimize
splintering
➤
20
➤
.010˝
555264
➤
.029˝
555263
“
Best all-around
Wood, plastics Fast-cutting, improved
chip clearance,
fibrous materials
smooth finish
➤
2
911389
$6.76
(12)
$6.76
(12)
$6.76
(12)
$6.76
(12)
911388
Wood, plastics
fibrous materials
✍
“I’ve owned a MARK V
since 1978 and have
used it to build hundreds of (small and large)
projects in a tiny basement
shop. Anyone who says you
need a barn-sized shop to build
top quality projects, obviously
doesn’t know a MARK V owner!”
~ Don P., Dayton, OH
www.shopsmith.com
The Shopsmith 6˝ Belt Sander – Big 6˝ wide belt and and loads
of great features eliminate hours of tedious hand sanding!
Loaded With Work-Saving, ResultsEnhancing Benefits and Accessories
As with all Shopsmith Special Purpose Tools, your Belt
Sander offers a number of great features and accessories
to help you make everything you make – better.
MARK V or Stand Mount
Every Shopsmith Special Purpose Tool offers the option
of mounting and powering it with your Shopsmith MARK V
or with its own, individual, motorized Stand.
See Page 26 for Power Stand information
Few tools will save you more work and time than a Belt Sander. Its
straight line action removes stock quickly and easily ... then smooths
surfaces and edges to a glass-like surface by changing to a fine grit Belt.
What you’ll do with your new Shopsmith Belt Sander
Belt Sanders are the ideal tool for smoothing the surfaces and edges of
both narrow and wide boards. You’ll use it to make easy work of home
shop sanding jobs such as:
• Removing unsightly mill marks from sawn stock.
• Sanding bevels, miters and other cuts while using the Table
to maintain a precise angle or size.
• Contour sanding odd-shaped workpieces on the back side
of the Belt (which runs free without a Back-Up Plate).
• Sanding protruding joinery (finger laps, lap joints, mortise-andtenons, dovetails, etc.) flush with workpiece edges or surfaces.
• Sanding small or unusually-shaped parts that may be difficult
or impossible to hold for sanding with hand-held power sanders.
When you want to remove stock quickly, sand across the grain. When you
want to smooth stock, sand with the grain. In fact, thanks to its straightline cutting action, you can produce surfaces or edges that are smooth as
glass and straight as an arrow by merely changing to a fine grit belt.
When you need true 90° edges, position the Work Table along the side
of the Belt so its surface is 90° to the Belt surface ... then use the Table
as a precision Rip Fence-type guide.
When you need precise, 2-way 90° corners, position the Work Table
across the Belt with its surface 90° to the Belt surface ... then use the Table
as a precision back-up to maintain the angle of the stock during sanding.
When you need precise, 3-way 90° corners just use your Belt Sander’s
Table slot to bring your MARK V’s Miter Gauge into the equation for even
more control.
6˝ x 9˝ Support Table
Tilts and locks into position to help you
control sanding angles and to act as a
back-up during certain operations. It may
be used across the Belt, parallel to it on
either side, or at any angle for support
when surfacing or edging stock. Your
MARK V’s Miter Gauge or the Shopsmith Tenon Master Jig See Page 45
may be used with the Table for added control.
Automatic Belt Tensioning & Tracking
Just twist the Tensioning Knob until it clicks to release
the tension for Belt changes. Then, depress the Knob
release Lever and everything snaps back to normal
automatically. No tension settings required. Special
High-Crown Drum helps to keep the Belt on-track at
all times, without the need for constant adjustments.
Free-Running Belt On Back Side
Since the back side of the Belt has no back-up
Plate, it will flex and give to match the external
contours of workpieces like the leg shown here.
Built-In Dust Collection Port
2 1/2˝ Dust Collection Port helps you capture the fine dust created
by your Belt Sander before it gets into your shop environment.
Auxiliary Power Shaft
5/8˝ Shaft extends from the Drive Roller
to accept the Shopsmith Drum Sander.
Or, use your Shopsmith 1/4˝ Router
Chuck See Page 16 to hold our Small
Drum Sanders. See Page 72
$459.99
555355 Shopsmith 6˝ Belt Sander
Includes Instruction Manual and one 80-Grit Belt (555680)
The Shopsmith Belt Sander is a Special Truck Shipment item
and requires an additional $25 shipping fee.
Power Coupler
required for use with
Shopsmith MARK V or
Power Station
See Page - 26
Specifications
Belt Size ................................................... 6˝ x 48˝
Work Table Size ......................................... 6˝ x 9˝
Table Tilt ................................ “0” to 20° into Belt
45° away from Belt
1-800-543-7586
Backup Plate ................ 6˝ x 16 1/32˝ (14˝ to the left
[or above] Table surface
Bearings ................... (4 Ball) Two on Drive Drum
Two on Idler Drum
Drums ............................................(2) 3˝ diameter
Drive Drum rubber coated
Speed ....................................1,150 to 1,900 rpm
(recommended)
Weight .......................................................36 lbs.
Shopsmith 6˝ Belt Sander
15
Open-Coat Aluminum Oxide Sanding Belts
offer extended durability
These 6˝ x 48˝ open-coat Aluminum Oxide Belts cut fast and are more resistant to
clogging than their closed-coat counterparts. Made with a heavyweight “X”-grade
cloth backing for optimum durability under continuous use, the Aluminum
Oxide composition of our belts makes them the preferred abrasive
for most machine sanding operations.
555006
150-grit – Ultra Fine (1)
555402
150-grit – Ultra Fine (4)
120-grit – Very Fine (1)
120-grit – Very Fine (4)
100-grit – Fine (1)
100-grit – Fine (4)
80-grit – Medium (1)
80-grit – Medium (4)
60-grit – Coarse (1)
60-grit – Coarse (4)
555005
555401
942191
555399
555680
555400
555367
555403
$11.54
$43.14
$11.54
$43.14
$11.54
$43.14
$11.54
$43.14
$11.54
$43.14
942193 Belt Assortment Pkg.
Includes one each –
80, 100 & 120 grit belts
942194 Belt Assortment Pkg.
514632 1/4˝ Router Chuck
$18.98
Drum Sanding
Accessories
Use any of our Drum
Sanders on your Belt
Sander’s Auxiliary
Spindle - Page 72
Safety Push Block
keeps your hands out
of harm’s way
Ergonomically designed
device features canted
handle to help keep your
knuckles from being skinned
by Fences and other devices that could get in
the way. Non-slip rubber bottom pad.
518220 Push Block
16
$19.53
$28.97
Includes one each –
60, 100 & 150 grit belts
YOU SAVE $5.65
Protect your Belt Sander with this
rugged, fitted Cover
Our 1/4˝ Router Chuck lets you
use Shopsmith’s Extra Long Drum
Sanding Set on your Belt Sander’s
Auxiliary Shaft
Just slip this Router Chuck onto
your Belt Sander’s Auxiliary Shaft
and you’ll be ready to Drum
Sand all types of projects with
our 1/4˝ shaft Extra Long Drum
Sanding Set. A better choice
than using your Drill Chuck,
since most geared Chucks
(including ours) are not designed
to withstand side deflection
pressure.
$28.97
Dust Respirator is always a good
idea when Sanding
Uses a special Organic Vapor Cartridge to block
out harmful dust, mist and most sprays. Made
of a soft, rubber-like material that conforms
snugly to the contours of your face and provides
a comfortable fit.
522503 Dust Respirator
522502 Replacement
$30.98
$15.77
Cartridges (2)
$4.44
521409 Pre-Filter
Required for proper and optimal use
Cleaning Stick makes Belts
last four times longer!
Just hold this
special Stick
against your
moving Belt,
Disc or Drum
and watch as
they’re cleaned
to as-new
condition. 11/2˝ x 11/2˝ x 8˝ long. A real
money-saver.
753523 Abrasive Cleaning Stick
Belt Sander Accessories
This rugged, cotton/
polyester cover is
custom-sewn to
the shape of your
Shopsmith Belt
Sander. The special
urethane coating
repels moisture while
a unique perforation
process allows any
moisture that might
get in from below to
escape, preventing rust and corrosion.
515302 Belt Sander Cover
$23.57
Belt Sander Upgrade
Belt Sander Retro-Fit Kit dramatically
improves dust collection efficiency
For Shopsmith Belt Sanders made
before 8/87
Lets you switch
from a small
diameter,
11/4˝ port to a
double-sized
2 1/2˝ diameter
port for far superior dust collection. Includes
all mounting hardware plus an Elbow to help
prevent hose kinking.
300002 Belt Sander Retro-Kit
$20.77
$10.99
www.shopsmith.com
The Shopsmith 4˝ Jointer – Delivering the super-smooth edges
you need for professional-looking results on all your projects
Loaded With Work-Saving, ResultsEnhancing Benefits and Accessories
As with all Shopsmith Special Purpose Tools, your Jointer
offers a number of great features and accessories to help
you make everything you make – better.
MARK V or Stand Mount
Every Shopsmith Special Purpose Tool offers you the
option of mounting and powering it with your Shopsmith
MARK V – or with its own, individual, motorized Stand.
Power Stand Information – See Page 26
Since Jointers are frequently referred to as Jointer/Planers, they’re one of the
most misunderstood of all woodworking machines. Here’s the straight scoop.
Safety Featherguard
Special Guard is spring-loaded to exert continuous pressure against the workpiece, forcing it
against the Fence while you make your cuts.
To increase or decrease tension, just loosen
the Tension Adjustment Knob, move it along
its adjustment arc and tighten.
What you’ll do with your new Shopsmith Jointer
Jointers are used to smooth and square board edges in preparation for
glue-up into wider panels ... mostly for cabinet and furniture projects.
Simple Knife Leveling and Clamping System
Thickness Planers, on the other hand, are used to bring boards to a
Your Shopsmith Jointer’s individual Knife leveling screws let you adjust
precise, pre-determined thickness by shaving their surfaces and making
each Knife end up-and-down individually to compensate for variations
them parallel with one another. More about this on Page 21
created during sharpening. As a result, you’ll be able to sharpen your own
So, can you “thickness” on a Jointer? The answer is yes – and – no.
Knives using our special Planer/Jointer Knife Sharpener, without the need
Although a Jointer will plane and smooth surfaces (no wider than its
for costly professional match-grinding. See the next page for more about
Knives), since they offer no provisions for keeping one surface of your
the Planer/Jointer Knife Sharpener.
stock parallel with the other, true “thicknessing” isn’t normally a job for
Full Tilting Fence
the Jointer.
The Fence on your Shopsmith Jointer
How big should a Jointer be? If it’s going to be used primarily for
tilts up to 45° left or right and offers
planing the edges of boards (with only an occasional need to surface
adjustable
auto-stops at common angles
narrow stock) – and since few people work with stock thicker than
for
rapid
adjustment
convenience.
4˝ – why pay for capacities you don’t need?
Here are a few other jobs your Shopsmith Jointer
Built-In Dust Collection Chute
will handle quite nicely:
Built-in 2 1/2˝ Dust Collection Chute
BEVEL OR CHAMFER EDGES – Create smooth, precisely beveled or chamhelps you capture the dust and
fered edges on boards for angled cabinetry; making decorative interior
debris before it gets into the
or exterior columns; creating a bowl or vase glue-up for lathe turning; or
shop environment.
cooperage (barrel/container-making) projects. No sanding required!
ELIMINATE CUPPING – Boards are often cupped or hollow on one side.
As long as they’re no wider than 4˝, you can eliminate this cupping with
555483 Shopsmith 4˝ MARK V Mount Jointer
$489.99
a few light Jointer passes. This will, of course, change board thickness.
Includes Instruction Manual and two Safety Push Blocks.
SQUARE LARGE STOCK – Squaring large (thick) stock on a Table Saw can
often tax its capabilities ... especially with resinous woods. Use your
Jointer to deliver a perfect 90° angle on stock up to 4˝ thick every time.
Power Coupler
required for use with
No sanding required!
Shopsmith MARK V or
FORM PRECISION EDGE RABBETS & TONGUES (up to 3/8˝ deep) – Form a
Power Station
perfect, 90° rabbet or tongue (for tongue-and-groove joints) along the edge
of a board with your Shopsmith Jointer. No sanding required!
See Page - 26
TAPERING – Just clamp a stop block to your Jointer’s Fence and you can cut
perfect tapers for table legs, stair or deck posts and more. No sanding required!
CREATE OCTAGONAL COLUMNS OR POSTS – Just set the Jointer Fence at
The Shopsmith Jointer is a Special Truck Shipment item
45° and make a series of passes to “pre-round” square stock for Latheand requires an additional $25 shipping fee.
spindle turning ... or to create perfect octagonal columns or posts. No
sanding required!
Specifications
Max. width of cut. .............................................4˝
Max. depth of cut (single pass) ......................1/8˝
Max. depth of rabbet cut ...............................3/8˝
Infeed Table....................................... 51/2˝ x 13 1/4˝
Outfeed Table.....................................41/2˝ x 131/4˝
1-800-543-7586
Overall Table length ........................................28˝
Fence .....................................................3˝ x 21 3/4˝
Fence tilt ................................45° left to 45° right
Fence auto-stops (Adjustable @) ....45°, 90° & 45°
Cutterhead diameter ......................................21/2˝
Knives ........................... 3 precision-ground steel
Bearings .......................... 2 sealed, ball bearings
Speed (recommended) ........... 3,900 – 6,200 rpm
Weight .......................................................53 lbs.
Mounts on MARK V, Power Stand or Power Station
Shopsmith 4 Jointer
17
Save time and money – sharpen your
own Planer and Jointer Knives with
this handy Jig
Auxiliary Fence Pkg. helps you work
safer and with improved stability
Jointer Upgrades
A
B
C
A. Jointer Dust Chute Retro-fit Kit collects
This 7 /4˝ high Fence attaches quickly to your
Jointer or MARK V Rip Fence and offers a
smooth-gliding, laminate-covered surface. Use
it for added support when working with wide
boards. Also accommodates two Featherboard
hold-downs for increased safety when jointing
narrow, difficult-to-hold boards. Order the Fence
only – or as a Pkg., including 2 Featherboards.
3
Don’t let nicked or dull Planer or Jointer Knives
stop your projects dead in their tracks ... or ruin
their appearance. Now you can precision grind
your own Planer or Jointer Knives with this
easy-to-use device.
Just clamp your Knives into this special Jig,
grasp the two large handles and sharpen them
to a keen, nick-free edge, using our Conical
Sanding Disc or Disc Kit.
Conical Sanding Discs – See Page 73
Special nylon glides on the back and bottom surfaces smooth the Jig’s travel. A simple,
fail-safe system, complete with step-by-step
instructions for use.
555471 Planer/Jointer
555655 Auxiliary Fence Pkg.
$69.92
shavings at the source
For Shopsmith Jointers with serial
numbers prior to 70,000
Update older Shopsmith Jointers for improved
dust collection. Includes: rear blade guard,
inner guards and chip chute. Some drilling
and tapping required.
555077 Jointer Dust Chute
$34.22
Retro-fit Kit
YOU SAVE $5.37
555653 Auxiliary Fence (only)
555654 Featherboards (2)
$57.84
$17.45
Protect your Jointer with this
rugged, custom-fitted Cover
B. Jointer Featherguard Retro-fit Kit improves
safety and precision for Shopsmith Jointers
with aluminum Blade Guards
For Shopsmith Jointers with aluminum
Blade Guards
Dual-purpose Guard covers rotating knives
to keep hands out of harm’s way. Single
knob adjusts featherboard tension to hold
workpiece against Jointer fence for more
precise cuts.
$74.83
Knife Sharpener
Be Prepared! Spare set of Jointer
Knives can keep you working
through emergencies
NOTE: You may need to purchase the Retro-fit
Installation Kit listed below.
555480 Jointer Featherguard
$53.91
Retro-fit Kit
C. Jointer Featherguard Retro-fit Installation
Set of three hardened steel knives, precision
match-ground to Shopsmith’s exacting requirements. Our rigid quality control standards
ensure that every knife blade will be exactly
the same size, with the same precision edge
bevel to guarantee accurate cuts, even if used
in conjunction with old blades! Once the blades
are ground and honed to produce a keen cutting edge, they are treated with a special rust
preventive solution for lasting serviceability.
We recommend having a spare set of knives
handy at all times, in case of accidental nicking.
This way, “down time” will be kept to an absolute
minimum, and you will be able to continue work
on your project without interruption.
$49.99
505640 Replacement
Jointer Knives
18
Jointer Accessories
This cotton/polyester cover is custom-sewn to
the shape of your Shopsmith Jointer. The special
urethane coating repels moisture while a unique
perforation process allows any moisture that
might get in from below to escape, preventing
rust and corrosion.
515303 Jointer Cover
$23.57
Kit (for B, above)
Includes (1) #3 drill bit, (1) 1/4-28 tap
and (1) tap handle for installing the Jointer
Featherguard Retro-fit Kit listed above.
NOTE: If you already own these tools, you will not
need to purchase this Kit.
555559 Jointer Featherguard
$16.57
Retro-fit Installation Kit
Jointer Tips & Techniques
Two tips for jointing highly figured woods
1. Wipe the board with a damp cloth a few minutes prior to jointing to
soften the wood fibers.
2. Attach a long, shop-made, wooden wedge (4˝+ high is preferred) to your
Jointer Fence that tapers from about 2˝ thick at the infeed end to about
1/2˝ thick at the outfeed end. This Fence will force the wood to cross the
Jointer Knives at a slightly skewed angle, resulting in a smoother cut.
www.shopsmith.com
The Shopsmith Strip Sander – Saves hours of tedious sanding,
grinding and sharpening of wooden, metal or plastic shapes
Loaded With Work-Saving, ResultsEnhancing Benefits and Accessories
As with all Shopsmith Special Purpose Tools,
your Strip Sander offers a number of great features
and accessories to help you make everything you
make – better.
MARK V or Stand Mount
Every Shopsmith Special Purpose Tool offers the
option of mounting and powering it with your
Shopsmith MARK V – or with its own, individual,
motorized Stand.
See Page 26 for Power Stand information
Oversized Tilting Table
Large 11˝ x 11˝ die cast aluminum Table
tilts from “0” to 45° for accurate beveling
or sharpening jobs. Generous size provides
plenty of support for your most critical jobs.
The Strip Sander is an often forgotten, value-priced workshop addition
that will save you countless hours of tedious work sanding or grinding
intricate external or internal shapes. In addition, it’s also a fabulous choice
for polishing or sharpening chisels and other edged shop and garden tools.
What you’ll do with your new Shopsmith Strip Sander
The narrow belt (1˝ or 1/2˝) Strip Sander will give you the same kinds
of work-saving convenience you’re accustomed to with full-sized Belt
Sanders ... just on a smaller scale. You’ll use it to make easy work of
intricate sanding, grinding and sharpening jobs such as:
• Smoothing the external edges of small craft, model or delicate
miniature projects. It’s the perfect companion for your Bandsaw
or Scroll Saw.
• Using its unique Belt re-thread capability to sand or grind the
intricate internal cut-outs on all types of projects.
• Grinding metal objects or shaping plastic parts.
• Sharpening lawn and garden tools.
• Putting a keen cutting edge on bevel-edged or turning chisels using
our optional Chisel-Sharpening Attachment See Page 20
You’ll find a full range of available belts from 50-grit to 600-grit –
and either 1˝ or 1/2˝ widths. There’s virtually no small-scale job your
Shopsmith Strip Sander can’t tackle.
Interchangeable
Flat and Curved
Platens
You’ll get three interchangeable Platens to
support the Belt during straight or curved
sanding or grinding jobs. Choose from 1˝ or 1/2˝
wide Flat Platens or the 1/2˝ radius Curved Platen. You can also remove
the Platen completely for unsupported light
sanding of delicate workpieces.
Exposed Upper Tracking Wheel
Perfect for sanding the flowing external curves
of valances, decorative trim and similar projects.
Simple Tracking Adjustments and
Automatic Belt Tensioning
A quick twist of the single Tracking Knob keeps the Belt running straight
and true ... while the spring-loaded Tracking Wheel automatically keeps
the Belt on-track, without fiddling.
Built-in Dust Collection Port
Just connect the hose from your Shopsmith
Dust Collector to the Port and go to work, as
the sanding/grinding is trapped before it can
spread throughout the shop.
555309 Shopsmith Strip Sander
$289.49
✍
Includes three Platens, Instruction Manual and three Belts
(80-grit Garnet, 150-grit Aluminum Oxide and 220-grit Aluminum Oxide)
My workshop is equipped with my Shopsmith MARK V, a
Bandsaw and a Jointer. I also have a free-standing Planer,
Scroll Saw, Belt Sander, Dust Removal System and a Router. I
can honestly say there seems no end to what the combination of my
equipment can produce.
~ Russ Troisi, Panama City Beach, FL
Power Coupler
required for use with
Shopsmith MARK V or
Power Station
See Page - 26
Specifications
...................................................6
Belt Size .........................1/2˝
x 42˝ – or – 1˝ x 48
42˝
Size............................................................6
x 9–
Platens
............................... 1/2˝ & 1˝ Flat – Plus
Table Tilt ................................ “0” to
20° into
Belt
Radius
Curved
45° away from
Work Table Size .....................................
11˝ xBelt
11˝
1
(5 /2˝ of Table in front of Platen)
1-800-543-7586
Table
TiltPlate
........................“0”
to1Ú
45°
forward
(only)
32 (14
Backup
............. 6 x 16to the
left
Throat Depth .............................
6˝ behind
Platen
[or above]
Table surface
Maximum
Stock Thickness
Bearings ...................
(4 Ball) Two on Drive Drum
External Sanding..........................................4˝
Two on Idler Drum
Internal Sanding (piercing cuts) ................31/4˝
Speed
............ (recommended) 700(2)to32,050
rpm
Drums ...........................................
diameter
Dimensions ............................
17˝L rubber
x 11˝W coated
x 15˝D
Drive Drum
Weight
.......................................................15
lbs.
Speed ....................................1,150
to 1,900 rpm
(recommended)
Weight .......................................................36 lbs.
Shopsmith Strip Sander
19
Chisel Sharpening Attachment makes
your Shopsmith Strip Sander a
sharpening whiz!
High-quality Strip Sander Belts for a variety of sanding,
grinding or sharpening jobs
We offer a full range of premium Belts in your choice
of 1/2˝ or 1˝ widths. The selection includes grits from
50-grit (coarse) through 600-grit (super-fine).
Aluminum Oxide (A/O) Belts are great for general
purpose sanding and grinding, while our 600-grit
Silicon Carbide (S/C) Belts are recommended
primarily for sharpening.
All belts are offered in packs of five
1˝ Aluminum Oxide Belts (A/O)
555341 60-Grit
555342 80-Grit
555338 100-Grit
555343 150-Grit
555344 220-Grit
555345 320-Grit
555346 400-Grit
1/2˝ Garnet Belts
$15.11 555333 80-Grit
$15.11 555334 100-Grit
$15.11 555335 150-Grit
$15.11 555336 220-Grit
$15.11 Special Assorted Belt Kits
Assorted Kit (A/O)
$15.11 942251 (11˝each)
60, 80, 150, 220 & 320
$15.11 942249 1/2˝ Assorted Kit (Garnet)
$15.11
$11.54
(1 each) 80, 100, 150, & (2) 220
1˝ Silicon Carbide Belt
555347 600-Grit
$11.54
$11.54
$11.54
$11.54
$20.78
Shopsmith Utility Light illuminates
your view of Strip Sanding operations
521897 1˝ Superfine Kit (A/O)
$15.11
(1 each) 150, 220, 320, 400 & 600
2X Shade-Mount Magnifier reduces
eye strain
Add this easy-to-use Attachment to your
Shopsmith Strip Sander and you’ll be putting
super-keen, razor-sharp edges on all your
Bench and lathe chisels before you know it!
Just replace your Strip Sander’s Table with
this Attachment, switch to the special angles
Sharpening Platen and you’ll be ready to start
sharpening in less than two minutes.
Drop the butt end of your Chisel’s handle into
the Holder, adjust for length and desired angle,
tighten and start sharpening. It’s that easy!
Includes Attachment, Platen, Upper Drum
Guard and Superfine Assorted Belt Kit (521897).
555812 Strip Sander Chisel
This utility light brightens your work area. Its
flexible gooseneck allows easy adjustment to
put light right where you need it. Includes one
bracket, two self tapping screws, drill bit and
instructions.
Buy extra support brackets so you can move
your light from machine to machine, or better
yet, save when you order the Three Utility Light
Set for all your Special Purpose Tools.
555503 Utility Light
555557 Three Utility Light Set
$59.08
$155.34
YOU SAVE $21.90
555520 Extra Support Bracket
$4.55
✍
I’ve enjoyed my MARK V for several
years and have accumulated nearly all
of the Special Purpose Tools. It’s great
because I’m cramped into a small garage, yet
still enjoy the compact flexibility of the MARK V
like I had a large basement.
~Dave Limber, Virginia Beach, VA
20
Get a close-up view of small projects or tolerancecritical processes with the 2X Power Magnifier.
It attaches to the shade of any of Shopsmith’s
Utility Lights. It’s perfect for zooming in to get a
super-clear view of miniatures and similar small
projects – or any tolerance-critical operations.
The 2˝ deep by 4˝ wide premium-quality, high
clarity glass lens provides a larger field of view.
522200 Shade-Mounted
$104.58
Sharpening Attachment
Protect your Strip Sander with this
custom fitted Cover
$25.93
Magnifier
Abrasive Cleaning Stick makes your
sandpaper last four times longer!
Just hold this
special stick
against moving belts, discs
or drums and
watch as they’re
cleaned to nearnew condition.
It’s 11/2˝ x 11/2˝ x 8˝ long – a real money-saver!
753523 Abrasive Cleaning
Strip Sander Accessories
Stick
$10.99
This rugged, cotton/polyester cover is customsewn to the shape of your Shopsmith Strip
Sander. The special urethane coating repels
moisture while a unique perforation process
allows any moisture that might get in from
below to escape, preventing rust and corrosion.
516260 Strip Sander Cover
$23.57
www.shopsmith.com
Shopsmith’s 12˝ Planers – MARK V Mount or “Pro” Model
Delivering the precise stock thickness you need – EVERY TIME!
Loaded With Work-Saving, ResultsEnhancing Benefits and Accessories
As with all Shopsmith Special Purpose Tools, your Thickness Planer offers
great features to help you make everything you make – better.
Large, 12˝ x 4˝ capacity handles big lumber
Generous capacities let you turn even heavy, rough-sawn timbers into
smooth, finished stock up to 12˝ wide.
Plenty of muscle to tackle your toughest jobs
While the MARK V Mount Model will deliver up to 11/8 hp at infinitely
variable Cutterhead speeds of 3,000 to 4,100 rpms ... the Pro Planer
comes with its own Operating Stand and 13/4 hp Motor that gives you
a constant, 5,750 rpm Cutterhead speed.
Depending on the types of projects you build, the Thickness Planer could
easily be one of the most important additions to your home shop.
Why do you need a Thickness Planer?
The first and foremost reason is to ensure the consistency of the thickness of the stock you’re using. Few problems are more frustrating than
to start assembling your cut-to-size project components, only to discover
that they’re not fitting together properly due to inconsistencies in thickness.
Assuming that all lumber (even from the same stock) is planed down to
a consistent thickness, has been the downfall of many a project.
The second reason is to save money by planing your own lumber to the
thickness you want. When you need thinned stock for smaller gift projects,
for example, these savings can be significant. If you can find 1/4˝, 3/8˝
or 1/2˝ thinned stock locally, you’ll pay dearly for it. But, armed with a
Shopsmith Bandsaw See Pg. 8 and one of our Planers, you can resaw
two or three thinner boards out of a thicker one (up to 6˝ wide), then
plane them down to the exact thickness you need ... at a big savings!
Choose MARK V Mount or “Pro” Stand-Mount
Every Shopsmith Special Purpose Tool offers the option of mounting and
powering it with your Shopsmith MARK V – or on a motorized Stand. In
the case of the Planer, our stand-mount version is called the “Pro Planer.”
A third option for Planer buyers ... The Shopsmith Thickness Planer
and Scroll Saw are the only two of our Shopsmith Special Purpose Tools
that offer you a choice of three powering options:
1. If you’re confident that you’ll be using your
Planer often ... the Pro Planer is probably your
best choice. At 64 lbs., MARK V Mount Planers
can be a bit heavy for some older or physically
disadvantaged woodworkers with a frequent need.
They’ll appreciate having the Pro Planer mounted
on its own Stand, ready to go to work.
2. If you’re only going to use your Planer occasionally – or have a limited budget ... the MARK V
Mount Unit is probably best for you.
3. If you’re not certain but think you may eventually want a Stand-Mount
Model ... Shopsmith lets you start with a budget-priced MARK V Mount
Model now, and add the convenience of a Power Stand later, if you like.
See Page 26 for Power Stand information
1-800-543-7586
Separate Feed Motor won’t rob
power from Cutterhead
Both Shopsmith Planer Models offer a
separate Feed Motor that’s completely
independent of the Cutterhead Motor.
As a result, you’ll achieve better, more
consistent Planer performance since each
of the two motors is dedicated entirely to
its own function.
Variable-Rate Feed Control
ensures super-smooth,
mirror-finish cuts
Although the feed rate ranges vary
slightly between the two Models, both
Planers allow you to slow-down or speedup the feed rates to produce as smooth a
surface as you’d like – at the simple twist
of the Feed Rate Dial.
28˝ long Table provides
unrivaled workpiece
support
The Shopsmith Planer has one
of the longest Tables of any
12˝ Planer on the market today.
Its rigid, durable construction
eliminates leveling problems and
ensures the proper infeed and
outfeed support to produce a consistent depth-of-cut on every board.
High-Grip Feed Rollers help prevent slippage
The serrated steel Infeed Roller grabs every board (even heavy, 4˝ timbers)
with a secure, non-slip grip – then pushes it through the Cutterhead at a
constant feed rate. The long-lasting, hard rubber Outfeed Roller then grasps
the stock as it exits the Cutterhead, pulling it through at that same rate.
505990 Shopsmith 12˝ MARK V Mount Planer
$1,395.20
Includes Instruction Manual.
Requires Power Coupler for use with MARK V See Pg. 26
555082 Shopsmith 12˝ Pro Planer
Includes steel Power Stand with 1 3/4 hp Motor
and Instruction Manual
$1,774.84
The Shopsmith Thickness Planer is a Special Truck Shipment item
and requires an additional $25 shipping fee.
Shopsmith Thickness Planer
21
Choose the Shopsmith Planer model
that best meets your needs
Specifications
MARK V Mounted
Pro Planer
Maximum width-of-cut
12˝
12˝
Maximum depth-of-cut
3/32˝
1/8˝
4˝
4˝
Maximum stock thickness
Minimum stock thickness
3/32˝
3/32˝
Variable: 3,000 – 4,100 rpm
Fixed: 5,750 rpm
Cutterhead diameter
3˝
3˝
power
1
3
Cutterhead speed
1 /8
Feed motor horsepower
Planer Pulley Retro-Kit helps older
stand-mounted Shopsmith Planers
produce smoother cuts
1 /4
1/2
1/2
Feed rate (feet/minute)
5 – 12
7 – 20
Electrical requirements
110V, 15 amps
110V, 15 amps
Minimum cuts-per-inch
62
72
Maximum cuts-per-inch
205
205
1
Planer Upgrades
1
Table size
12 /2˝ x 28˝
12 /2˝ x 28˝
Weight
64 pounds
151 pounds
For stand-mounted Shopsmith Planers
with two equal-sized pulleys
Increases Cutterhead speed from 3,450 rpms to
5,750 rpms ... and cuts-per-inch by two-thirds
... from 86 CPI to 143 CPI (at 10-feet-per-minute
feed rate) for super-smooth surfaces.
Includes (2) steel (not aluminum) Pulleys, Belt
and unbreakable ABS plastic Pulley Guard, plus
all mounting hardware.
555114 Planer Pulley Retro-Kit
Planer Dust Chute helps you collect
flying chips and sawdust at their
source
Attaches to Shopsmith Planers (either model).
A real must for those who like to keep a neat
and tidy shop. Includes 2 1/2˝ Elbow.
300001 Planer Dust Chute
$37.37
Having a spare set of Planer Knives
could keep you working in the event
of a nick or other Knife problem
High-quality, hardened M-2 steel cutting edge
is laminated to a low carbon steel backup. This
provides a keen-edge-holding ability and strength,
without being brittle. Set of three.
505982 Replacement Planer
$109.99
$34.43
Knurled Infeed Roller stops slipping
on older model Shopsmith Planers
For stand-mounted Shopsmith Planers
with serial numbers below 20,000
555115 Knurled Infeed Roller
$52.25
Knives
Planer Knife-Setting Gauge (not shown)
In the event you’ve lost yours.
513414 Planer Knife-Setting
$5.82
Gauge
Planer-Jointer
Knife Sharpener
Keep your Planer and
Jointer Knives sharp
& performing at their
best. See Page - 18
Hearing Protector blocks out the
harmful, high-pitched whine of
machines
Lightweight, comfortable Protector filters out the
whine of Table Saws, Planers, Jointers, Routers
and other high-speed tools. Features self-adjusting Headband and soft, comfortable pads.
720709 Hearing Protectors
22
$20.78
Thickness Planer Accessories
Planer Dust Chute Retro Attachment
For use with all 300001 Planer Dust
Chutes manufactured before 6/1/92
555643 Planer Dust Chute
$28.46
Retro Attachment
Custom-fitted Dust Cover protects
your Planer from dust and moisture
Rugged, cotton-polyester cover is custom-sewn
to the shape of your Shopsmith Planer (both
models), features a special urethane coating that
repels moisture while allowing the Cover to breathe.
515305 Thickness Planer Cover
$23.57
www.shopsmith.com
The Shopsmith DC3300 Dust Collector – Helps you enjoy
a virtually dust-free workshop environment
When it comes to sucking-up sawdust and wood chips,
Dust Collectors reign supreme over shop vacuums!
Loaded With Hard-Working Features
As with all Shopsmith Special Purpose Tools, your DC3300 Dust Collector
offers a number of great benefits and accessories.
Powerful 1/2 hp Motor
Sealed, fan-cooled motor develops up to 3/4 hp – more than enough to
provide simultaneous dust-collection for multiple machines with up to
98% efficiency.
Exceptional Hook-Up Versatility
With three Inlet Ports, your DC3300 can serve up to three machines at
once. Or, replace the 3-way-Inlet with our optional 4˝ Inlet Assembly and
connect it to a permanent, hard-piped system to serve the whole shop.
Large, 4-Vane, Low-Noise Fan
You get maximum airflow with minimum noise. What more could you ask?
Shopsmith’s DC3300 Dust Collector was engineered specifically as a
compact, efficient way to suck the wood dust and shavings out of your
running Shopsmith machines ... before they mess up your shop, equipment, clothes and home.
Then, when you’ve finished working, you can turn it into an air-cleaning
whiz by simply disconnecting the hoses, opening all three of its inlets and
turning it on. The DC3300 will remove any lingering airborne particles
(as small as 7 microns – only 1 micron with optional 42˝ Hood) from a
12˝ x 12˝ shop in about 10 minutes – while you’re straightening-up.
Shop Vacuum vs. Dust Collector
Heavy-duty shop vacuums are great for sweeping floors, sucking-up water
and all those other general clean-up jobs around the house and garage.
But they can’t hold a candle to a dedicated Dust Collector when it comes
to capturing large volumes of shavings and superfine dust from woodworking
machinery. NO CONTEST!
Most shop vacuums are wet/dry units. They need a lot of static pressure
to suck up nuts, bolts, water and other heavy stuff. Dust Collectors, on the
other hand, could care less about heavy stuff. Their job is to snatch 90+%
of the dust and debris from your machinery ... before it ever has a chance
to get loose and become a problem.
To do that job, you need CFM (cubic-feet-per-minute) ... not static
pressure ... and that’s exactly what Dust Collectors deliver – in HUGE quantities.
In fact, three times – or more CFM – than a conventional shop vacuum.
Huge 30-Gallon Waste Capacity
Heavy-duty, 30-gallon, see-through Dust Bags attach and remove with a
quick-release-style Retaining Strap.
Oversize Wheels & Casters
Move your DC3300 around the shop with practically zero effort!
Generous 12-Foot Power Cord
No need to look for an extension!
Compact Size Saves Shop Real Estate
Requires only 21˝ x 26˝ of floor space – just
48˝ high (with standard Filter Hood).
15 Standard Accessories
The only full-featured Dust Collector that
comes with all these Standard Accessories:
• TWO 2 1/2˝ x 8˝ Hoses
• TWO Inlet Plug assemblies w/Caps
• Wide, Floor Pickup attachment • Clamp-On Utility Pickup
• Elbow Brush attachment
• SIX Disposable Dust Bags
See Pg. 24 for NEW Wireless On/Off Switch
• TWO 20˝ x 21/2˝ Wands
$549.99
330002 Shopsmith DC3300 Dust Collector
Includes Instruction Manual plus 15 Standard Accessories listed above.
The Shopsmith DC3300 Dust Collector is a Special Truck Shipment item
and requires an additional $25 shipping fee.
Optional Filter Hoods let you choose your level of Dust Collection Efficiency –
The Filter Hood of a Dust Collector cleans Where The Cake Always Comes First!
A
B
C
the air that’s returned to the environment once the
dust is removed. As it does this, a “cake” of dust
forms on the inside of the Hood. The thicker the cake,
the smaller the dust particles it will hold captive inside.
Our larger 24˝ and 42˝ Hoods offer nearly four times
the surface area of our original equipment Hood, helping them maintain optimum airflow, even though particle size is reducing. Made of a special polyester felt,
they’re fully washable, though it’s seldom necessary.
Surface Sq. In.
A. = 679
B. = 1357
C. = 2375
Smallest Microns Captured
7
5
1
A. 514808 Original Equipment,
12˝ Hood
B. 300008 24˝ Filter Hood
C. 555942 42˝ Filter Hood
$35.20
$35.77
$78.93
Specifications
Motor ..................8 amp, 1/2-hp, capacitor-start,
industrial-duty
Airflow....................................................330 CFM
1-800-543-7586
Bag Capacity ...................................... 30 Gallons
Dimensions ............................. 21˝w x 26˝d x 48˝h
Power Cord .............................................. 12-feet
Weight .............................64 lbs. (approximately)
Shopsmith DC3300 Dust Collector
23
Shopsmith Dust Collection System Accessories
NEW
A
Wireless On/Off Switch
Easy, affordable Wireless On/Off Switch lets
you turn your Shopsmith Dust Collector On or off
from anywhere in the room – at the push of a button!
Just plug the Receiver into any outlet and plug
your DC3300 into the Receiver outlet. You’re
now ready to turn your collector on or off from
anywhere in the shop (within 100-feet) at the
push of a button. That’s it! No wiring. No
permits required.
Rated at 120VAC/8A with a standard
3-prong plug and slave outlet. Compact pocket Transmitter runs on single 12V, type 23A
alkaline battery (included). At this price, if you
have a dust collector, this is a must-have!
556021 Wireless On/Off
$29.76
Switch
Additional DC3300 Hoses, Fittings, Bags & Accessories
Hook-up more machines or extend
your reach with additional hoses
21/2˝ Elbow reduces strain on Hoses
Use on machines with sidemounted hookups to relieve
hose strain.
8˝ x 21/2˝ diameter
vacuum hose.
Male/Male.
$7.39
514521 21/2˝ Elbow
B
C
A. Utility Vacuum Extension collects dust
and shavings as you work
Features a 21/2˝ opening for connection
to the DC3300. Special Support Brackets
attach directly to machines to accept a
strong, flexible, vinyl-covered gooseneck that
rotates a full 360° for unlimited positioning.
Includes: Extension Assembly, small Floor
Pickup, Support Bracket; hardware, drill bit,
plus instructions for installation. Order extra
Brackets for each machine.
555582 Utility Vacuum
$52.95
Extension
$4.55
555520 Extra Support
Bracket
B. Easy hook-ups for all your power tools
Attach these Ferrules to a 21/2˝ hose to make
all your power tools and fixtures
dust-collection capable!
710130 Flange Ferrule (1)
$8.61
710135
Flange Ferrule (4)
$22.98
C. Elbow Dusting Brush
300004 8˝ x 21/2˝ DC3300 Hose
$25.61
Couple hoses
together for extra
length
Replacement Dust Bags
Six heavy-duty, 30-gallon, see-through bags
(see DC3300 Hose photo above).
300006 DC3300 Dust Bags (6)
Use only with 21/2˝ diameter
hoses. Female/Female.
$12.87
515430 2 1/2˝ Hose Connector
Special Reducer for
11/4˝ diameter Hoses
$4.61
Foot Switch provides quick, handsfree activation of your DC3300
Dust Collector
21/4˝ Inlet Plug with
Cap
Use smaller diameter
hoses for tools with 11/4˝
hookups. Large end is
female, small end is male.
300007 21/2˝ to 11/4˝ Reducer
$6.26
Used to “sweep” shelves, walls, and tools.
Standard with DC3300 Dust Collector. Fits
on hoses with a 21/2˝ opening.
514828 Elbow Dusting Brush $17.45
Improves air flow when
fewer than three hoses are
used on the DC3300.
514929 2 1/4˝ Inlet Plug with Cap
$4.69
Hose Valves turn hoses on and off, at the machine or at the DC3300
Hose Valves open or close airflow to any accessory
to improve performance and eliminate hose changes.
Easy-Pull slider mechanism. Attaches to the DC3300
or any Shopsmith accessory.
555468 Dust Collector Hose Valve
$18.56
Perfect for use with our DC3300 Dust Collector,
depress once to turn on – again to turn off.
Becomes your “third hand” when working with
large stock.
13 AMPS – 12-foot Cord, no Safety Guard.
711124 Unguarded ON-OFF
$38.63
Switch
24
Dust Collector Accessories
www.shopsmith.com
Planer Dust Chute catches debris
at the source
Dust Collection Upgrades
Bring your earlier model Shopsmith equipment up to the latest in dust
collection efficiency with these special upgrades
Two upgrades bring added dust
collection efficiency and safety
to your Model 500 MARK V
A
Jointer Dust Chute Retro-Fit Kit
minimizes workshop mess
B
Hook-up your Shopsmith Planer to a DC3300
Dust Collector or other shop vacuum for dustfree operation. Includes 21/2˝ elbow.
300001 Planer Dust Chute
$37.37
Model 500 Disc Sander Dust Chute
tames one of messiest operations
A. Model 500 Lower Saw Guard Upgrade
For Model 500 MARK V’s, serial
numbers below 222396
$45.90
555294 Model 500 Lower
Saw Guard Upgrade
See Page 6 for more information
For Shopsmith Jointers with
serial numbers prior to 70,000
$34.22
555077 Jointer Dust Chute
Retro-Fit Kit
See Page 18 for more information
DC3300 Handle Retro-Fit Kit
B. See-Through MARK V Saw Guard System
See Page 38
For Model 500 MARK V’s with aluminum
Upper and Lower Saw Guards
$184.36
505875 Model 500 Clear
Guard System
555167 Model 500 Disc
For use with early model Shopsmith Planer
Dust Chutes (300001) manufactured prior
to 6/1/92
555643 Planer Dust Chute
Extension Wand
For Dust Collectors made prior to
May 2000
This inexpensive, simple-to-install Kit lets you
attach an additional Handle to the top of the
3-Way Inlet on your DC3300 for convenience
when moving it around the shop. Includes the
handle, two screws and a template for marking
pilot hole positions. You’ll need a center punch,
a 5/32˝ drill bit and a Phillips screwdriver to do
the job. Takes about 5 minutes.
521769 DC3300 Handle
$15.87
Retro-Fit Kit
$28.46
Retro Attachment
Belt Sander Retro-Fit Kit doubles size
of dust collection Chute
For
Shopsmith
Belt Sanders
made before
8/87
For earlier model
Shopsmith Bandsaws
without a Dust Chute
300000 Retro-Fit Bandsaw
Wands can be used with
utility nozzle or brush
attachment for floor,
machine, shelf and bench clean-up. 20˝ long,
two standard with DC3300 Dust Collector.
514825 Extension Wand
$18.29
Dust Chute Attachment
See Page 11 for more information
1-800-543-7586
300002 Belt Sander
$20.77
Retro-Fit Kit
See Page 16 for more information
$10.96
14˝ Utility Nozzle
Combined with two 20˝
extension wands (514825),
makes floor pickup quick, complete and easy
without back bending effort. Nozzle standard
with DC3300 Dust Collector.
514826 14˝ Utility Nozzle
Bandsaw Dust Chute collects loads
of fine dust, right at the source
$55.95
Sander Dust Chute
See Page 6 for more information
Planer Retro-Fit Attachment
improves Dust Chute efficiency of
early model Shopsmith Planers
Attaches to earlier
Model 500 MARK V’s
to help you gain
control over one
of woodworking’s
messiest operations, Disc Sanding.
Standard with all Model 505, 510 and 520/Pro
Fence System MARK V’s and all Table System
Retro-Fit Kits. Requires current, standard steel
Sanding Disc (555143) for operation.
$12.06
Practically nothing escapes this
Super-efficient Drum Sander/ Shaper
Vacuum Attachment
Attaches to the bottom of the Shopsmith
Shaper/Drum Sander
Table Insert (for ALL
MARK V models) with
two bolts. Concentrates vacuum power right at
the source.
$12.53
555168 Drum Sander
Vacuum Attachment
Dust Collector Accessories
25
Only Shopsmith’s versatile Special Purpose Tools give
you three innovative mounting and powering options
1. MARK V Mount
2. Individual Stand-Mount
3. Power Station Mount
If your space and/or budget are limited and
you own a Shopsmith MARK V ... this may be
your best option.
Each of our six Special Purpose Tools were
designed specifically to be supported and
powered by your Shopsmith MARK V - with
absolutely ZERO performance compromises.
Just switch them, one for the other, as
needed. Dial-in the correct speed for each
operation and go to work. Each Tool works
flawlessly with your MARK V as its support
system and power supply ... because that’s
what it was designed to do.
Then, when you’re finished with them, store
them conveniently and compactly out of the
way on the Shopsmith Storage Station or on the
shop-built Special Purpose Tool Storage Rack
that’s included in our plans for Shopsmith’s
Complete Home Workshop Storage and
Organizing System.
If you have the space ... and prefer that
frequently-used Tools be ready-to-go ...
this is a great choice for you.
Specially configured Power Stands – with
appropriate Motor and multi-speed (except
Jointer and Planer) belt-and-pulley drive
systems are available for each Tool.
If you want the ability to select different
ready-to-go Tools based on your projects
this choice lets you ...
1. Switch between Tools in a flash.
2. Dial-in the speed you need for each Tool.
3. Power multiple Tools and save space, too.
The perfect choice for those who depend on
the space-saving convenience of their MARK
V’s, yet also want to bring a selected ready-togo tools into play, based on project needs.
See Page 27 for Storage System & Plans
Shopsmith
Power Stands
give you readyto-go working
convenience
Includes:
• Sturdy, heavygauge steel Stand.
• Heavy-duty,
1/2-hp Motor w/ Cord (11/2-hp for Planer).
• Switch with removable safety Key.
• Cast aluminum Mounting Base 505655 (not
required for Planer) • Appropriate Tool and
Motor Pulleys • V-Belt • Protective Belt Guard.
555059 Bandsaw
$336.29
Power Stand
Delivers 770 & 1,150 rpms
555058 Belt Sander
$336.29
Power Stand
Delivers 1,150 & 1,725 rpms
555056 Jointer
The Shopsmith Power Coupler
Making the connection between your
Special Purpose Tools and your MARK V
The Shopsmith Power Coupler is made of a
virtually unbreakable plastic compound. Each
end mates with splined metal Hubs that attach
to your MARK V and Special Purpose Tool.
The Coupler Kit is standard equipment with all
MARK V’s manufactured after April, 1985.
555124 Power Coupler Kit
$31.99
Coupler, two metal Hubs and setscrews
503574 Power Coupler
Coupler only without metal Hubs
26
$21.49
$336.29
Power Stand
Delivers 3,900 rpms
555805 Strip Sander
$336.29
Power Stand
Delivers 985, 1,480 and 1,975 rpms
555369 Scroll Saw
$336.29
Power Stand
Delivers 190, 265, 300, 395,
475, 675, 700 & 990 strokes-per-minute
505977 Planer
$382.60
Power Stand
1 /2 hp - Delivers 5,750 rpms
1
The Planer Power Stand is a Special Truck
Shipment item and requires an additional
$15 shipping fee (Planer only)
Mounting & Powering Options
The Shopsmith Power Station ®
A full horsepower of variable-speed
Special Purpose Tool muscle – PLUS –
quick Tool changes, too
It’s like having a “mini
MARK V,”
standing
by to support and
power your
Shopsmith
Special
Purpose
Tools when
you need an
extra hand.
Twin-Tube Mounting Base lets you switch from
Tool-to-Tool in seconds.
Dial-In Variable Speed Control lets you select
the correct speed (850 to 3,850 rpm) with a
quick twist then go to work. No belts or pulleys.
Rugged, High-Torque Motor develops up to a
full horsepower to give you more than enough
power for your toughest jobs.
555422 Shopsmith Power
$599.99
Station
(includes Power Coupler)
516261 Power Station Cover
$23.57
The Power Station is a Special Truck
Shipment item and requires an additional
$20 shipping fee
www.shopsmith.com
Great Shop Storage Solutions For Your Tools & Accessories
Here’s a great home for your
resting Special Purpose Tools
Store up to three of your Shopsmith Special
Purpose Tools in an upright position to protect
your tool investment. Each Tool quickly slips
into and out of the holes in the aluminum
Mounting Bases, just as they do in your MARK V’s
Headrest. The complete Kit includes the Stand,
three aluminum Mounting Bases and a set of
Retractable Casters for mobility.
$298.39
555761 Storage Station
The Shopsmith Storage Station is a
Special Truck Shipment item and
requires an additional $10 shipping fee
Wall-mounted Storage System holds
the Tables, Tubes and Legs for your
Model 505, 510 or 520 MARK V
Aluminum Mounting Bases are
the perfect way to store your
Special Purpose Tools
Improved MARK V Accessory Shelf
holds frequently used MARK V
attachments
Cannot be used with MARK V Cabinets
This sturdy 1˝ thick wooden Shelf holds Saw
Guards, Rip Fences, Miter Gauges, Lathe
Tailstocks, Blades, Lathe Tool Rests and other
accessories for ALL MARK V Models. May also
be mounted to workbench, wall or cabinet.
Engineered for strength and convenience, the
rugged extruded aluminum Brackets will store
your Work Table, two Floating Extension Tables,
four Connector Tubes and two Telescoping Legs
out of your way when not in use.
Just mount the two Brackets to a piece
of scrap stock (not included) and attach the
assembled System to the wall. You’re done.
Kit includes two Brackets, one 45˝ Mounting
Tube, screws and Instructions.
555941 MARK V Table
$40.79
Storage System
(Also great for storing your Support Table)
1-800-543-7586
Just attach
these aluminum
Bases to a
cabinet-top or
shelf for easy
slip-on/slip-off
storage of any
Shopsmith
Special Purpose
Tool when not
in use.
505655 Aluminum Mounting
Base
$44.99
555953 MARK V Accessory
$78.92
Shelf
Shopsmith Gift Cards
make a great gift!
Order online 24 hours a Day
www.shopsmith.com/ownersite/giftcard/index.htm
Shop Storage Solutions
27
Choose from a full complement of over 300 MARK V Accessories
They’ll help you tackle practically any operation with ease
No other Woodworking System can match the variety of versatile, work-saving accessories offered by the Shopsmith MARK V System. NONE!
So, when you’re ready to move ahead to more complex projects, your Shopsmith MARK V is ready to move ahead with you.
It’s the most expandable, Complete Home Shop System in the World.
Work smarter – Grow faster
Successful woodworking depends on learning new skills and sometimes,
specialized tools will help you learn those skills faster. Here’s an example.
To make some attractive, tongue-and-groove wainscoting for the
walls of your dining room, you could cut the mating joints with multiple
passes of a saw blade or dado set. Tedious, but it can be done.
Or, you could save a lot of work by using a tongue-and-groove knife
set with a Molder or Shaper set-up. Timeless accessories from Shopsmith.
With very few exceptions, the Accessories we develop for today’s
Model 510 and 520 MARK V’s will work with the Model 500 MARK
V your father or grandfather bought in 1953. So, remember ... when
you’re ready to build your skills into new territory, we’re ready to help
you do just that.
Quick Reference Accessory Index
Biscuit Joining ...........................44
Chisel Mortising .........................43
Drilling ................................. 74-76
Dust Collection .................... 23-25
Incra® Products........ 31, 41-42, 85
Lathe Turning ...................... 77-81
Miter Pro™ .................................36
Molding & Shaping .............. 67-70
Project Plans .............................89
Routing ................................ 44-48
Sanding ............................... 71-73
Sawing ......................................37
Saw Blades ...............................34
Sharpening .......................... 38-40
Shop Accessories .......... 28, 84-88
Speed Increaser.........................32
Speed Reducer ..........................33
The Shopsmith MARK V Lift-Assist
Reduce the amount of effort required to raise your MARK V from Table Saw to Drill Press mode
by 60%,
65%, 76% – DOWN TO ZERO! ... with the Shopsmith MARK V Lift-Assist
Pounds of lift effort required
with & without Shopsmith Lift-Assist
Headstock
distance
from left
side of
MARK V
0
8˝
12˝
20˝
Pounds
of effort
required
WITHOUT
Lift-Assist
65 lbs.
57 lbs.
50 lbs.
35 lbs.
Pounds
of effort
required
WITH
Lift-Assist
25 lbs.
20 lbs
12 lbs.
SELF-LIFT
Model MARK V. Destined to become the favorite
accessory of many MARK V Owners.
555975 Shopsmith Lift-Assist
$189.99
$189.99
555998 Shopsmith Lift-Assist
But now there’s a great little helper available
For MARK V’S manufactured BEFORE 1972
to take the majority of this effort out of the
equation entirely. No matter what your reason
This is the accessory many MARK V owners
for needing a little Assist-ance ... in about half
Using Shopsmith’s Lift-Assist
have been wanting for some time. As we get
an hour to an hour’s time, your new Shopsmith
with our Steel Storage Cabinets
older, we’re not as strong as we used to be ... Lift-Assist will be doing that lifting work for you.
and those things that were once easy for us
Again, we’re not talking about just a fraction
are now a bit more difficult. It’s all a part of life. of that effort ... but 60%, 65%, 76% up to ...
Lifting the MARK V from horizontal to vertical
When using the Lift-Assist, all three Cabinets
position is one of those procedures that can get EVERY LAST DROP OF EFFORT ... you
will
not fit between the MARK V’s legs.
would normally exert to raise the MARK V.
a bit tougher with age. The taller you are, of
If your Cabinets are on casters, only one
course, the higher you’ll want your Drill Press
The complete Kit includes the Lift-Assist Arm,
Cabinet will fit. Without casters, two cabinets
Table once it’s raised ... and the more difficult
gas-charged Cylinder, hardware and simple,
will fit.
it gets to make the move.
step-by-step instructions for adding it to any
28
MARK V Accessories
www.shopsmith.com
Make Workshop Safety Your Number One Priority
Award-winning Shopsmith Safety Kit
keeps hands out of harm’s way
D
C
A
B
Complete kit includes Push Stick, 2 rubbersoled Push Blocks, adjustable Rip Fence
Straddler and Featherboard
505973 5-Piece Safety Kit
$70.31
(Model 500,505 & 510)
521675 5-Piece Safety Kit (Model 520) $70.31
YOU SAVE $8.57
Also available individually:
A. 518221 Push Stick
$5.95
B. 518220 Push Block
$19.53
C. 518215 Featherboard
$15.23
D. 518218 Fence Straddler
$17.89
Pair of Router Table Featherboards
enhance the precision and safety
of your Router Table Kit
Just attach them to the threaded inserts in
the surface of your Shopsmith (555658)
Router Table with the four Knobs and Washers
(included). Use them to hold your workpieces
firmly against the Fence during operations
while keeping your hands out of harm’s way.
555878 Router Table
$26.06
Featherboards
Flip-up
Shield
keeps flying
debris out
of your eyes
and face
517071 Ratchet Face Shield
$19.87
521273 Replacement Shield
$4.91
(Models 505 / 510 only)
521107 Fence Straddler
$17.89
(Model 520)
Hearing
Protectors
block out
harmful
machine
noises
Adjustable see-through Lathe
Shield protects you from flying
chips and debris
Vertical-mount Featherboard
provides reliable safety hold-down
for Rip Fence-guided operations
Rigid steel angle bracket lets you attach this
Featherboard anywhere along the length of the
T-slot channel in the top of your Model 505,
510 or 520/Pro Fence Rip Fence. Just position
it where you want and tighten the two Knobs.
Holds workpieces as thick as your Rip Fence
is high. (Models 505, 510 and 520 only.)
555783 Rip Fence-Mount
$22.55
Featherboard
Just mount this 12 5/8˝ x 11˝, impact-resistant
see-through Shield to the back of your MARK V’s
Headstock using our special Mounting Support
Bracket and go to work. 24˝ Gooseneck Arm
slips on and off the Mounting Bracket without
tools. Order extra Brackets for use with other
machines. Both items include all mounting
hardware and instructions.
522198 See-through
$54.27
Lathe Shield
555520 Extra Support Bracket
$4.55
The highpitched whine
of Table Saws,
Jointers, Planers and Routers can be very
damaging to the ears. These Protectors block
out these noises while still allowing you to hear
shop conversations.
Scratchresistant
Safety
Goggles
Safety Grip stops workpiece creep
Attaches to Shopsmith Miter Gauge. Provides
five times your grip in hold-down pressure.
505625 Miter Gauge
$20.78
720709 Hearing Protectors
Ventilated to
prevent fogging. Will fit
over glasses.
$46.29
Safety Grip
513456 Safety Goggles
1-800-543-7586
Workshop Safety
$5.51
29
Enjoy added workpiece support, operating convenience
and mobility with these great MARK V Accessories
Double-up your outboard workpiece
support with this Extension Table
Package for MARK V’s with the
Model 505 or 510 Table Package
7 1/2˝ wide Extension Table
gives your Pre-1990
MARK V a full
50˝ of ripping
capacity
Retractable Casters bring extra
convenience and mobility to
all your Shopsmith Tools
Supports long boards when
sawing, sanding or boring.
It provides an additional 7 1/2˝
wide table surface for outboard
support – plus – allows an
additional 4 3/4˝ of ripping capacity.
Table and fence bar are fully adjustable
for precise alignment with saw table. Offset
mounting offers a full 50˝ ripping capacity
when used with a rip fence on the left side
of MARK V’s made before 1990.
555084 Extension Table
$142.88
With mounting bracket & tubes
555085 Extension Table
$79.56
Top only
Imagine having the same kind of extended
workpiece support on both sides of your
MARK V at the same time. This package gives
you exactly that ... and, at a $50+ savings, too!
Includes (2) Floating Extension Tables,
(2) Telescoping Legs, (2) T-Joint Fittings and
(4) Connector Tubes.
555137 Extension Table Pkg.
$289.14
For MARK V’s with Model 505 or 510 Table Pkg.
YOU SAVE $50.03
Individual components available
514446 Floating Extension
$124.01
Table (1)
514439 2˝ Connector Tube (1)
514529 Telescoping Leg (1)
514520 T-Joint Fitting (1)
$11.45
$27.78
$21.41
Telescoping Leg provides added
table rigidity when Hollow Chisel
Mortising or performing other
heavy workpiece operations
Ideal for eliminating Work Table deflection
when machining heavy stock or during certain
Drill Press operations such as Hollow Chisel
Mortising ... where you may be exerting more
downward pressure than normal and need the
extra Table support.
Extends to 421/2˝ and works like your
Telescoping Extension Table Legs. Just slip
the notch in the top of the Leg under the
front Table “lip” and tighten the Knob to clamp
it into position.
555627 Table Support Leg
30
$35.27
MARK V Accessories
555354 MARK V Casters
Add 7˝ of table depth
to your Pre-1990
MARK V for
crosscutting
wide boards
555353 Planer/Power Station/
Power Stand Casters
(For all Shopsmith Special Purpose
Tool Stands, except Scroll Saw)
Attaches to the
front of a MARK V
Model 500 table
with a single-twist knob,
providing an extra-long slot for the miter
gauge and added workpiece support, too.
Brings increased accuracy to wide crosscuts.
Not for MARK V Models 505, 510 and 520
Table Systems.
505626 Front Table Extension
A single step on the Pedal raises the Tool 1/4˝
off the ground for easy mobility. A double step
raises it 1/2˝ and a third settles it back onto
the ground. Many customers have even added
these Casters to their work benches and other
shop cabinets.
555457 Stand-Mounted Scroll Saw Casters
$96.43 Each
$71.39
HTC Roller Stand
provides the perfect
companion when
working with long
or wide workpieces
Made of sturdy, 1˝ square
steel tubing with a 14˝
wide roller and a wide,
stable stance. Adjusts
from 281/2˝ to 44˝ high.
Front feet are 16˝ apart
and the back foot sits
13˝ back to form an equilateral triangle for
greater stability. Folds for easy storage.
The Shopsmith Support Table is now
a Roller Stand, too! Conversion Kit
available for older Support Tables.
See Page 37
740900 Roller Stand
$52.17
5-Foot Connector Tubes provide
additional support when working
with long boards and large panels
These extra-long, 5-foot Connector Tubes slip
easily into the main Work Table or Extension
Table Rails of your MARK V with a Model 505,
510 or 520 Table System.
Add a couple of extra Floating Extension
Tables (514446) and Telescoping Legs
(514529) – shown at left – and you’ll be
able to easily handle the largest panels or
the longest boards for crosscutting (2 tubes).
521942 5-Foot Connector Tubes
$48.54
www.shopsmith.com
Tool Set-Up & Alignment Aids
The quality of your results cannot exceed the accuracy of your set-ups
Practically nothing will affect the eventual quality of your woodworking projects more than the accuracy of your measurements and setups. If you fail to “measure twice/cut once,” all bets are off ... and if the tools you’re using to make your cuts are out of whack, your
results will probably be likewise. The devices presented on this page will help you achieve the quality results you want.
Get the right speed
setting for every
operation with this
handy Speed Chart
Matches rpm’s with MARK V
Speed Dial settings and
provides ideal speed for dozens of operations.
791500 MARK V Speed Chart
$4.55
Set-up or tune-up your tools and
operations with precision, using
this Dial Gauge
Measuring or transfer odd angles
with the Mite-R-Gauge Protractor/
Bevel
This Gauge will help you align your MARK V’s
Work Table, Rip Fence or Miter Gauge pre-sets
for precise cuts, time-after-time.
Align your Miter Gauge to an exact 45° or
90° setting. Achieve the smoothest edges and
surfaces by match-setting your Jointer Knives.
Micro-adjust the offset of Shaper and Router
Table Fences. Set the depth-of-cut for saw
blades, dado blades, router bits and more with
amazing accuracy. Measure the depths of holes
or dadoes ... the list goes on.
You get a large 2 1/4˝ diameter Dial Indicator,
graduated in 1/1000 (.001˝) with a full 1˝ range;
a set of 22 interchangeable Indicator Points for
tackling the toughest measuring jobs; a special
Mounting Block with adjustable Bracket; a 5˝
long Miter Bar and easy-to-follow illustrated
instructions for use.
The measuring and setting of precise angles is
extremely important in woodworking. Triangles
are ideal for most applications, but they will not
do for many “odd” angles.
The Mite-R-Gauge Protractor/Bevel features
long legs with direct-reading protractor scales
that make easy work of this otherwise difficult
job and allows you to measure and read the
angle in a single step ... within 1/2 degree.
Once the angle is set, a quick twist of the
knob locks the gauge in position for transferring
to your table saw or other machine.
730342 Mite-R-Gauge
$21.99
Protractor/Bevel
555884 Dial Set-Up Gauge
$69.99
Special Gauge helps you verify
accurate router bit depths
Set Miter Gauge Angles with 1/2°
accuracy using this Precision
Protractor
Set your Saw’s depth-of-cut in an
instant with this Gauge
Just set the Gauge on your work table, move
your blade into position with a tooth touching
the appropriate step on the Gauge ... and lock
the blade into position.
Gauge provides 16 steps from 1/8˝ to 2˝ in
1/8˝ increments. Also works for setting Router
Bit depths and rip cut widths on Table Saws
and Bandsaws.
739990 Aluminum Step Gauge
1-800-543-7586
$8.39
A dado or groove that’s too deep can jeopardize
the strength and ruin the appearance of a joint.
This handy gauge eliminates these problems by
providing accurate settings in an instant.
Just rest the gauge’s feet on your router’s
base or your router table insert and move the
appropriate notch over the tip of your bit to make
your setting. Graduated in 1/16˝ increments
from 1/8˝ to 1˝. Can also be used to set saw
blade depths up to 1˝.
521939 Router Bit Depth Gauge
$8.39
This 21st century Marking Protractor has microfine guide holes at every 45°, 30° 22.5°, 5°, 1°
and 0.5° interval to plot any angle with ease and
absolute accuracy. A metal T-Bar and see-through
crosshairs provide exact alignment against the
edge of your workpiece. Remove the T-Bar to work
on flat surfaces. Contains four angle scales: 0°
left to 180° right, 180° left to 0° right, 0° top to
90° left and right, and 90° top to 0° left and right
suits every need. It’s easy on the eyes, incredibly
accurate, and just plain fun to use!
$31.39
522172 6˝ Incra Precision
Marking Protractor
(Calibrated to 1/2° & 1/32 ˝)
Set-Up & Alignment
31
Increase your MARK V’s speed to 10,000 rpms for Routing
and Shaping – with the Shopsmith Speed Increaser
Speed Increaser Fence supports your
stock before and after the cut
Dual Spindle
Guards for additional safety
Internal Mechanisms
allow for 10,000 rpm
at Speed Increaser
output Spindle
Features Independently adjustable infeed and
outfeed faces, rear Fence Guard, Shaper/Drum
Sander Table Insert and two Starter Pins.
555474 Model 500
$112.37
Increaser Fence
555475 Models 505, 510 & 520
$112.37
Increaser Fence
IMPORTANT NOTE
3-Point Clamping (at quill,
coupler and support bracket
assembly) provides for more
accurate cutting results and
enhances stability
Cast Iron Housing
provides for quality,
durability, and
dampens noise
and vibration
The Shopsmith Shaper/Drum Sander Fence
(555144, 555113) See Page 69 can be used
with the Speed Increaser. However, you must
use The Speed Increaser Shield (included
with Increaser) for optimum safety and dust
collection efficiency. ALWAYS use the Speed
Increaser Shield when performing under-table
Routing or Shaping operations.
Mount your Shaper Cutters to their
own Spindles for quick changes
when using the Speed Increaser
All of your Routing and Shaping operations will
be more efficient than ever with the Shopsmith
Speed Increaser on your team.
Designed for use with all MARK V Models,
the Speed Increaser will deliver a full 10,000
rpms at your MARK V’s “V” Speed Dial Setting.
As a result, you’ll have to make fewer passes
with your stock (especially when cutting full profiles) plus ... spend a lot less time sanding.
The Increaser’s under-table design also
provides another advantage by allowing you to
perform table Routing and Shaping operations
in a more conventional fashion ... with the bit
cutting from under the workpiece.
The special see-through Speed Increaser
Shield (included) hooks up to your Shopsmith
DC3300 Dust Collector See Page 23 or a shop
vacuum and does an amazing job of capturing
flying dust and debris.
Includes Speed Increaser; Shield; 1/2˝ Shaper
Spindle with four sizes of (non-bearing) Shaper
Rub Collars (555463); and all mounting hardware
for Increaser and Shield.
555462 Speed Increaser
$280.88
*Not for use at Speed settings other than “V”
32
Required for using
Shopsmith’s 1/2˝
Shaper Cutters
with the Shopsmith
Speed Increaser.
Includes four different diameter Rub Collars for
performing profile shaping operations.
555463 1/2˝ Speed Increaser
$25.18
Shaper Spindle
The Shopsmith Speed Increaser boosts your MARK V’s
maximum rpm to 10,000 for super-smooth,
super-fast Routing and Shaping.
Speed Increaser
Spindle with frictionfree ball bearing
Rub Collars ends
workpiece burning
Identical to 555463 above,
except with Ball Bearing Collars.
555472 1/2˝ Speed Increaser
$35.94
Shaper Spindle w/Ball
Bearing Rub Collars
Shank Adapter lets you use 1/4˝
Router Bits with Speed Increaser
The see-through Shield protects your eyes
from flying chips and helps you collect the
dust before it becomes a problem.
Shopsmith Speed Increaser
(not shown)
555464 1/4˝ Speed Increaser
$11.51
Router Bit Adapter
www.shopsmith.com
Reduce your MARK V’s speed to 100 rpms for Turning, Drilling,
Sanding and more – with the Shopsmith Speed Reducer
Tapered Spindle
Flat for added
safety
Adapter Assembly
attaches firmly to the
quill for sturdiness
Cast Aluminum
Housing for quality
and durability
Internal Mechanisms
allow for 100–700 rpm
at Speed Reducer
output spindle
The Shopsmith Speed Reducer provides your
MARK V with a 7:1 ratio of speed reduction
(see Table below). So, instead of your standard
700 to 5,200 rpms, you’ll be operating at 100
to 743 rpms.
This will allow you to perform an even wider
variety of operations while increasing your ability
to achieve the kinds of results you want.
For example, with your MARK V set on “SLOW”
(700 rpms), the Output Spindle of your Speed
Reducer will actually be turning at just 100 rpms.
Then, as you turn up your MARK V’s Speed
Dial, your low-end speeds increase accordingly ...
THE NEED FOR (the correct) SPEED
Achieving professional-looking results often
depends on having the right tools for a particular job. And, operating those tools at the optimal speed is as important as having them.
Your MARK V gives you a wide range of
speeds to handle most jobs at the twist of a
Dial. However, occasionally, you need a speed
that’s either faster or slower than your MARK V
can deliver without a little help.
That’s where the Shopsmith Speed Increaser
and Reducer will step in to deliver speeds that
are either slow enough for oversized turnings and drill bits ... or fast enough for certain
Routing or Shaping operations. (See Table)
* The Speed Increaser is designed to deliver 10,000 rpms with
the MARK V Speed Dial set at “V,” and is not intended for use
at other Speed Dial settings.
1-800-543-7586
all the way up to a maximum speed of 743 rpms
when you reach the “FAST” setting.
A few tasks that will be made easier
for you with the Shopsmith Speed
Reducer:
• Cut, drill, sand or grind metals and plastics
with the MARK V or Special Purpose Tools.
• Bore large diameter holes in hard woods
without burning your bits.
• Create heavy and/or oversized Faceplate
turnings on the Lathe.
• Eliminate burn marks when sanding with
the Disc or Drum Sander.
KEY FEATURES
• 3-point clamping (at Quill and around Way
Tubes) provides stability.
• Double Poly-V Belt Drive system is positive
in its action and designed to last.
• Reverse tapered Spindle flat helps keep tool
from slipping off if loose.
• Rugged, cast aluminum Housing delivers
rugged durability.
$297.85
555428 Shopsmith Speed
Reducer
Table of MARK V Speeds using Increaser and Reducer
Speed
Dial
Setting
SLOW
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
Mark V
Speed
700
750
850
950
1,050
1,150
1,300
1,450
1,600
1,750
1,900
2,050
2,200
With
Increaser
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
With
Reducer
100
107
121
136
150
164
186
207
229
250
271
293
314
Speed
Dial
Setting
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
FAST
Mark V
Speed
2,400
2,600
2,800
3,000
3,250
3,500
3,800
4,100
4,400
4,700
5,100
5,200
With
Increaser
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
10,000 *
—
—
Shopsmith Speed Reducer
With
Reducer
343
371
400
429
464
500
543
586
629
671
729
743
33
Good results begin with a good
Saw Blade Basics
Since most jobs begin with cutting your stock
to size, having the right blade is important.
Blade buyers should consider ... 1. Cut
quality 2. Cutting efficiency 3. Blade durability.
Cut Quality – Although Combination blades
deliver excellent cuts in most situations, there
are compromises. The best cuts are produced
by job-specific blades. If you’re doing a lot of
continuous ripping, use a Rip blade. If you’re
frequently switching between ripping and
crosscutting, a slight trade-off in cut quality
will buy you back a lot in blade-changing time.
With carbide-tipped blades, cut quality
is also determined by tooth grind. Here, an
alternate top bevel grind severs the fibers
cleanly like a knife without tearing.
When ripping, a flat top ground tooth will
chisel the wood away very efficiently and
cleanly as it moves quickly through the wood.
Hollow-Ground blades produce some of
the smoothest cuts. They’re thinner near their
centers and have teeth with no set. So, even
though this allows them to make a very clean
cut, they shouldn’t be used for general sizing,
as saw kerfs are more likely to close when
using them, pinching the Blade.
Cutting Efficiency – The configuration of
teeth versus gullets and the thickness of the
blade help determine how efficiently it cuts.
Ripping’s large chip size requires deep
gullets that remove lots of waste, quickly. So,
most of the space is consumed by gullets,
leaving less space available for teeth.
Smooth crosscuts make fine dust, so more
teeth and shallower gullets produce the best
results.
And, since thicker blades consume more
horsepower during the cutting process than
thinner blades, it stands to reason that Thin
Kerf Blades will pass through the stock with
less effort while making the cut.
Shopsmith’s 10˝ Steel and Carbide-Tipped Saw Blades
Shopsmith offers both steel and Carbide-Tipped
Saw Blades to suit a variety of applications.
Each Blade has been manufactured to the highest standards to ensure the best performance.
A
B
C
Carbide
/ Steel
Purpose
Photo
Letter
Teeth/
Blade
Tooth
Grind
Part
Number
Price
Carbide
Combo
A
50
AB/FT *
555958
$60.47
Carbide
Rip
B
24
FT
555959
$55.11
Carbide
Crosscut
C
60
AB
555960
$71.70
* 40 Alternate Bevel Grind and 10 Flat Top Grind
† 5/8 Saw Blade Arbors have short shafts that will not accommodate Dado Blades
Shopsmith Saw Arbors
Having all of your
Blades mounted on
Arbors and ready to
go to work saves time
and effort when making Blade changes.
34
Saw Blades
Long handled Arbor Wrench
keeps hands away from sharp
Blade teeth during changes
Model 500 Arbors
505511 11/4˝ Blade Arbor
555321 5/8˝ Blade Arbor †
$31.99
$31.99
Models 505, 510, 520 Arbors
555130 11/4˝ Blade Arbor
555608 5/8˝ Blade Arbor †
$31.99
$31.99
Includes wrenches for 1 1/4˝, 5/8˝ and 1/2 ˝
Shopsmith Arbors.
515979 13˝ Arbor Wrench
$16.69
Specialty Sawing Package provide versatility at a nice savings
Blade Durability – With periodic cleaning
and proper care, carbide-toothed blades will
remain sharper (for considerably longer) than
their steel-toothed counterparts.
This is particularly true if you cut a lot of
extremely hard domestic or exotic woods ... or
composite materials like MDF, particleboard,
hardboard or laminates. Steel toothed blades
just won’t cut it (for long) with these materials!
On the whole, carbide-toothed blades are
the best all-around blade value ... delivering
the optimal combination of performance
and durability.
NOTE: All 10˝ Shopsmith Saw Blades require
a 11/4˝ Shopsmith Saw Blade Arbor. All
Carbide-Tipped Shopsmith Blades are thin
kerf (3/32˝ blades).
Carbide-Tip Specialty Package
Includes our Carbide-Tipped
Combination Blade (555958),
Carbide Rip Blade (555959),
Carbide Crosscut Blade (555960)
and three 11/4˝ Saw Blade Arbors.
556036 Carbide-Tip Specialty Pkg.
For Model 500
$245.95
556037 Carbide-Tip Specialty Pkg.
$245.95
For Models 505, 510 & 520
YOU SAVE $37.30
www.shopsmith.com
Saw Blade
Dado Basics
Premium quality Stacked Dado Set cuts precise dadoes or grooves
in particleboard, MDF, laminates and other tough materials
A
B
C
D
MARK V Sawing Table Inserts
Although Shopsmith’s standard 6˝ steel
Dado Blade Set is a great choice for cutting hard or soft woods, when you need
dadoes or grooves in any of today’s tough
composite materials, nothing beats the
durability of carbide...and this set.
E
Pre-Cut or Blank Inserts for all MARK V’s.
Pre-Cut Inserts (Aluminum alloy)
A. For Model 500 – 5/8˝ wide slot
5013799 Pre-Cut Saw Insert
$27.80
B. For 505, 510, 520/Pro Fence
51410004 Pre-Cut Saw Insert
$27.80
Blank Inserts (Polymer)
Used to make your own zero-clearance Inserts
for more workpiece support, less bottom-side
splintering, and NO dangerous scrap fall-through.
556222 CMT 6˝ Carbide-Tipped Stack Dado Set
C. For Model 500 – Blank insert
555500 Blank Saw Insert
$168.93
$19.52
D. For Models 505, 510, 520/Pro Fence
For use during non through-cutting operations
such as dadoing, molding, etc. where Upper
Saw Guard will not be used.
$19.52
555501 Blank Saw Insert
C
A
B
E. For Models 505, 510, 520/Pro Fence
Includes pre-formed cut-out for Upper Saw
Guard. For use during through-cutting (sawing) operations where the Upper Saw Guard
will be used.
$19.52
555518 Blank Saw Insert
Spray-on Cleaner removes pitch and
gum, restores Blade cutting efficiency
Pitch and gum build-up will affect Blade
cutting efficiency. Just spray this remover
on your Blades, allow to sit briefly, brush
off lightly with a small scrubbing brush,
rinse and dry.
943487 Saw Blade Cleaner
$8.02
B. Dado Table Insert
A. Polymer Shim Set won’t swell, wrinkle
or buckle
Includes a total of 14 shims in .002˝ (orange),
.005˝ (purple), .010˝ (navy) and .020˝ (black)
thicknesses. Allows you to add up to .138˝
to the width of your Stack Dado cuts. Oil
and grease resistant in a clear plastic box.
$14.50
521934 Polymer Dado
Shim Set
Made of pressure cast aluminum alloy with
11/8˝ wide slot. (510/520 Insert shown).
$27.71
505621 Model 500 Dado
Insert
555120 505/510/520 Dado
$27.71
Insert
C. 5/8˝ Dado/Molder Arbor
Long, threaded shaft accommodates Stack
Dado Set (A). Fits all MARK V Models.
$27.87
505506 5/8˝ Dado / Molder
Arbor
Shopsmith Gift Cards make the perfect gift
for your favorite woodworker!
Here’s the ideal solution for those last-minute gift-giving occasions, or those times when you just can’t decide what item(s)
to get for your favorite woodworker. Why not send a Shopsmith Gift Card and let them choose the gift they actually WANT?
Nothing could be easier!
Just call 1-800-543-7586 TOLL-FREE or visit
www.shopsmith.com/ownersite/giftcard/
to order a Shopsmith Gift Card.
• Specify any dollar amount ($10 min.), even
include a personal message to your recipient.
1-800-543-7586
• Give us your recipient’s email address. We’ll
send an interim Electronic Gift Card with a PIN
number that may then be used until the actual
plastic Gift Card arrives in the mail.
• Plastic Cards will be shipped to your recipient
free-of-charge, along with a copy of our current
Woodworking Products Catalog.
• Gift Cards may be used like a debit card
and redeemed by recipients online, over
the TOLL-FREE phone (1-800-543-7586), by
mail or online at www.shopsmith.com.
Sawing/Dadoing
35
Work Safer and improve the accuracy of your
results with these Table Sawing Accessories
C. Miter Gauge Safety Grip – Returns 5 pounds
F
E
D
C
$46.29
D. Model 500 MARK V Quick-Clamp Miter
Gauge Retro-Fit Kit – Replaces the thumbscrew adjustment mechanisms on older
Shopsmith Miter Gauges. A real time-saver!
555125 Quick-Clamp
A
Hardwood Miter Gauge Extension
of down pressure for every 1 pound of squeeze
pressure to prevent workpiece creep. Near
instant stock thickness adjustments.
505625 Safety Grip
B
Miter Gauge Extensions
$26.11
Retro-Fit Kit
Gain better workpiece control with this
extra long Miter Gauge face. With bolts
and Knobs.
505630 Hardwood Extension
$18.62
E. Crosscut Sliding Table Miter Bar – For use
Complete Miter Gauge Package
Includes Miter Gauge (A) with removable
T-Slot Washer and Safety Grip (B). For all
MARK V models.
555101 Complete Miter
$104.15
Gauge Package
YOU SAVE $8.17
A. Shopsmith Miter Gauge – Knurled knob for
changing angles. Features removable T-slot
washer, easy-to-read angle scale and microadjustable auto stops at common angles
(Safety Grip NOT included).
505700 Miter Gauge
$66.03
B. Miter Gauge Stop Rod – For making duplicate
length crosscuts and for certain sanding and
drilling operations.
505629 Stop Rod
$22.87
on MARK V and Bandsaw Work Tables.
516525 Model 500 Sliding
$24.89
Table Miter Bar
24˝ Aluminum Miter
Gauge Extension
(no T-slot washer)
516619 505, 510, 520 Sliding
$24.89
Table Miter Bar
(with T-slot washer)
F. MARK V Miter Bar – for Models 505, 510,
520. Includes T-slot washer.
518104 MARK V Miter Bar
$31.72
G. Sliding T-Nuts simplify the job of attaching
jigs and fixtures to Work Tables and Rip
Fences – Made to slip into Table
and Fence T-Slots and provide
two 1/4˝-20 threaded holes and
one 3/8˝-16 hole for bolts or
knobs with threaded studs.
514491 Sliding T-Nut (ea.) $5.99
Tired of near-perfect miters? The Shopsmith
Miter-Pro will put an end to that problem
Wood Stop Block can be adjusted to
make duplicate cross-cuts (up to 24˝).
Includes two knurled Knobs and
mounting bolts.
555429 24˝ Aluminum
$47.40
Extension
20˝ Aluminum Miter
Gauge Extension
™
The Miter-Pro features precision-machined
working surfaces (10˝ and 24˝ long) that join
together at an exact 90° angle for dead-on 45°
36
Sawing
miters every time! Cut half of your mitered corner
with one of your adjoining workpieces against
one face ... then cut your second piece against
the other.
No more trial cut after trial cut, fiddling
27/8˝ tall Extension attaches to Gauge
around with a simple task that this amazing
face via rear T-Slot with Bolts and Knobs.
tool makes possible in a matter of seconds.
Adjustable Flip Stop slides to left or right
The Miter-Pro’s non-skid abrasive faces hold
in top-mounted T-Slot. Extension (with
the stock firmly in place without moving while
Stop) slides left or right on Gauge face
you make your cuts, and the infinitely adjustfor setting cutoffs up to 20˝. Includes
able Stop Block lets you cut duplicate length
(1) Flip Stop and Mounting Hardware.
pieces (up to 24˝ long) time-after-time without
continual measuring.
556005 20˝ Aluminum
$62.95
Order an additional 24˝ Aluminum Miter
Extension
Gauge Extension (555429 at left) and you can
have two 24˝ working faces with adjustable
stops for even more convenience.
For additional
Flip-Stops ...
$111.08
555404 Shopsmith
™
See Page 76
Miter-Pro
(Includes 10 ˝ and 24 ˝ long surfaces)
www.shopsmith.com
Accessories for handling long or wide boards more safely
Shopsmith’s Support Table helps you handle long or wide boards
alone – even serves double duty as a Roller Stand!
Perfect for ripping long boards or large
panels, drilling, shaping, disc sanding or
performing almost any operation on difficultto-handle stock. Can also be used with
Model 505, 510 and 520 Floating Extension
Tables. Includes Roller Top, hardware and
instructions.
555306 Support Table
$199.21
(Model 500)
555307 Support Table
$199.21
(Models 505 & 510)
Attaches to the infeed or outfeed end of
any model MARK V worktable in seconds.
The other end is supported by a leg that
telescopes to match the worktable height,
then locks at the twist of a knob. The
table then tilts in unison with your MARK
V’s worktable. A 14˝ wide roller top (also
included) converts the adjustable leg for
use as a Roller Stand, if desired.
The generous 24˝w x 32˝d x 1˝ thick
tabletop is covered with a low friction,
easy-to-clean laminate. Two built-in relief
slots in its surface allow your Miter
Gauge Bar to pass the worktable’s edge.
555784 Support Table
$199.21
(Model 520/Pro Fence)
521651 Support Table
$42.08
Conversion Kit
(Required if Support Table was
purchased prior to Model 520 upgrade)
Check It Out!
The Shopsmith Support Table
is now a Roller Stand, too!
Conversion Kit available for older
support tables – the perfect
companion when working with
long or wide workpieces.
See Page 30 for more information
Extension Table Brackets let you use your
MARK V’s Floating Extension Tables as
Infeed/Outfeed Tables
These Brackets let you use
the Floating Extension Tables
that came with your MARK V
Model 510 or 520 as infeed/
outfeed supports when working with long or wide stock.
The System works with one of your MARK V’s 2˝
Connector Tubes plus a special 18˝ long Tube (with this kit)
to create a 30˝ deep by up to 18˝ wide surface, supported
on the opposite end by your Telescoping Legs.
Putting everything together takes less than 5 minutes
and gives you all the workpiece support and convenience
you could ask for. The Brackets will work either with a
Model 510 or 520 MARK V’* and feature a unique raising
and lowering system that lets you micro-adjust the heights
of the Floating Extension Table(s) for safe, smooth operation
using two Height Adjustment Setscrews.
The complete kit includes one 18˝
Connector Tube, two aluminum Bracket
castings, and all necessary hardware for
assembly and operation.
555997 Extension Table Brackets
$73.49
* These Brackets will also work with Model 505 MARK V’s, but require that you
purchase Floating Extension Tables (514446) and Connector Tubes (514439)
separately.
See Page 30
Enjoy the cutoff convenience an accuracy of a radial arm saw
with Shopsmith’s Cross-Cut Sliding Table System
This ingenious Sliding Table acts like a “sled” to support long or cumbersome workpieces and help you guide them safely and precisely through
otherwise difficult crosscuts. Need to cut an inch or so off the end of an
8-foot 2˝ x 12˝. No problem.
Its durable, laminated surface is a full 15 3/4˝ x 313/4˝ for plenty of
support. The Aluminum Fence adjusts quickly for 90°, 45°, 36°, 30°
and 221/2° angle cuts for making four, five, six or eight-sided projects.
Order it with your choice of MARK V Miter Bar ... or with none, for
mounting on competitive saws.
$107.30
555502 Cross-Cut Sliding Table
(For Model 500 MARK V)
$107.30
555535 Cross-Cut Sliding Table
(For Models 505, 510 & 520 MARK Vs)
$95.75
516524 Cross-Cut Sliding Table
(No Miter Bar – Use with other brand saws)
Auxiliary Table matches Cross-Cut Table height on
opposite side of Blade
Non-Slip Strip keeps your stock from moving
as you use your Cross-Cut Table
11/2˝ x 30˝ adhesive-backed Strip
attaches to your Sliding Table’s Fence to
prevent workpiece creeping. Also works
with your Miter Gauge or any Miter
Gauge Extension Fence.
516913 Non-Slip Strip
$6.46
1-800-543-7586
Features a Miter Bar on the bottom that
locks into the Work Table slot on the
opposite side of the Blade when the
Cross-Cut Table is in use. Its purpose is
to match the height and thickness of the
Cross-Cut Table to keep scrap material
from falling into the Blade and causing
a dangerous kick-back. Works with all
MARK V Models.
$47.21
555526 Auxiliary Cross-Cut Table
Sawing
37
The Shopsmith Sharpening Guide – and Planer/Jointer Knife Sharpener
Two fail-safe ways to put a razor’s edge on your Chisels, Machine Knives and Shaper Cutters
Planer/Jointer Knife Sharpener will
keep you in business in the event of
a nick or dull Blades
Sharp Chisels work best – and this
handy Guide takes the guesswork
out of keeping them that way
This Guide gives you the easiest way ever to
put a razor’s edge on your Lathe Chisels,
Bench Chisels and Shaper Cutters.
As you know, sharp tools can make a major
difference in the quality of your projects. Now,
Shopsmith has a solution for achieving those
super-sharp edges quickly and easily ... even
if you’ve never had good luck with sharpening.
Just mount the Guide to your MARK V’s
Work Table or Extension Table (instructions
included), adjust for the proper pre-set edge
angle and go to work. If you want a different
angle, simply re-set it to the personalized bevel
angle that meets your requirements.
The comprehensive Manual provides
detailed mounting and sharpening instructions,
so you just can’t miss. Includes:
• Shopsmith Sharpening Guide
• 12˝ Steel Sanding Disc
• 12˝ Cloth-backed Sandpaper
(3 pcs. 150-grit Aluminum Oxide)
• Step-by-step Instruction Manual
555193 Sharpening Guide Pkg.
$104.66
YOU SAVE $21.97
555204 Sharpening Guide (only)
555143 12˝ Steel Sanding Disc
38
$52.77
$55.60
Sharpening
Replacement Sandpaper Discs
for the Sharpening Guide:
555205 100-Grit, Alum. Oxide (3) $18.26
555206 150-Grit, Alum. Oxide (3) $18.26
NOTE: Although the Sharpening Guide is specifically designed for
use with Shopsmith Lathe Chisels, other brands or types of chisels
may also be sharpened with it, as long as Lathe Chisel blades are at
least 4 ˝ long and Bench Chisel blades 6 ˝.
Nicked Knives on your Planer or Jointer can
spoil the appearance of your projects and cost
you hours or days of delay as you sand out the
blemishes they’ll leave – or wait while you send
your Blades out to the sharpening service.
But now, this easy-to-use Sharpener will
save you the time that could be required to
sand out the nicks ... or the expense you
could face for sending your Blades out to be
professionally sharpened.
Just clamp your Knives into the self-aligning
Jig, grasp the two large Handles and use your
Shopsmith Conical Sanding Disc to sharpen
them to a keen edge.
Special nylon glides on the back and bottom
edges ensure the Guide’s smooth travel over
your MARK V Tabletop and against your Rip
Fence as it holds your Knives at the precise,
correct angle while you sharpen them.
This is truly the simple, foolproof way for you
to keep your Jointer and Planer operating at
peak performance ... no matter what happens.
Includes complete step-by-step instructions
for set-up and use.
555471 Planer/Jointer
$74.83
Knife Sharpener
Conical
Sanding
Disc
Brass Bevel Gauge helps you achieve
11 precision angles when grinding or
sharpening Chisels
This compact, 13/4˝ diameter Gauge includes
the most common sharpening angle for Chisels,
plus a 120° gauge for drill bit tips. Angles
include 15°, 17.5°, 20°, 22.5°, 25°, 27.5°,
30°, 32.5°, 35°, 45° and 60°.
521808 Bevel Sharpening Gauge
$8.81
See Page - 73
✍
The guys at work are sure tired of me
talking about my Shopsmith. Thanks
for my MARK V.
~ T. Wilson, Borger, TX
www.shopsmith.com
F
I
A
H
D
B
G
E
Sharpening Necessities
F. Honing Oil cleans and lubricates your
Sharpening Stones – Floats off metal and
abrasive particles that could clog the stone
and impede its performance.
C
$6.59
517064 Honing Oil (4 oz.)
G. Versatile, all-purpose Bench Stone – Two-
Keep all of your woodworking, garden and household
cutting tools true and sharp with the Shopsmith Grinding Wheel Guard
You don’t have to be an experienced woodworker to know that you need sharp tools to
achieve the best results with the least effort.
Lathe chisels, bench chisels and plane irons
all have cutting edges that need to be sharpened periodically to work properly.
Shopsmith’s Grinding Wheel Guard attaches
to your MARK V allowing you to grind or hone
all types of edged tools. You can also use it
to restore the performance of screwdrivers,
punches, garden tools, mower blades and
more – and perform a wide range of general,
in-shop grinding jobs.
Its versatile tool rest can be adjusted and
locked firmly into any angle up to 90° with
a quick twist of the oversized wing nut. Use
the rest in a vertical position with edges that
surround the wheel when sharpening chisels
and narrow edged tools – or in a horizontal
position for supporting wide plane irons.
The clear, see-through shield and spark
guard are both fully adjustable to provide
maximum protection for every set-up.
It attaches quickly and easily to the quill
of your Shopsmith MARK V. Use only with
Shopsmith 5˝ Grinding Wheels (not included).
Includes: Grinding Wheel Guard, SeeThrough Shield with Spark Arrestor and
5/8˝ Grinding Wheel Arbor.
A.
555470 Grinding Wheel
sided India Benchstone offers medium and
fine grit surfaces for all-around sharpening.
8˝ x 2˝ x 1˝.
731040 Combination Stone
$27.81
H. Hard Arkansas Slip Stone – The top
choice of the old-timers for final honing
to a keen edge.
516092 Hard Arkansas Slip
$17.59
I. Tapered, Fine India Slip Stone – The
best choice for honing Gouges and other
curved-edge Chisels.
731029 Tapered India Slip
$27.81
$69.39
Guard
B.
555302 5/8˝ Grinding
$26.66
Wheel Arbor
Grinding Wheels
C. 517475 Grinding Wheel
$23.19
Fine – 100-Grit
D.
517474 Grinding Wheel
$23.19
Coarse – 60-Grit
E.
517473 Grinding Wheel
Very Coarse – 36-Grit
1-800-543-7586
$23.19
Control precise sharpening and
honing angles with this English
Honing Guide
The best of all the Honing Guides we’ve tried.
Just clamp your Chisel or Plane Iron into the
Guide to establish the correct angle, then roll
it back-and-forth over your Sharpening Stone
to hone any edged tool from 1/8˝ to 2 5/8˝ wide.
Includes instructions for use and setting proper
bevel angles.
730440 English Honing Guide
Sharpening/Grinding
$11.99
39
The World’s Most Versatile
Shop Apron
This 100% fully washable cotton-canvas
Shop Apron is the most versatile apron
available today. Made in the USA, the cross
shoulder support design has fully adjustable
1˝ wide nylon web shoulder straps, and an
adjustable (to 52˝ waist) 11/2˝ wide nylon
web belt with a quick release buckle.
This unique apron has 20 variable-sized
pockets from a pocket for your pencil to a
huge 6 1/4˝ square, plus two rugged, 11/2˝
wide nylon web tool loops.
$44.28
521802 World’s Most
Versatile Shop Apron
Easy-to-use attachment turns your Shopsmith Strip Sander
into a Chisel Sharpening “Wizard”
Some types of woodworking chisels, including
many lathe chisels and carving chisels, require
edge angles that can be difficult to sharpen.
This inexpensive device solves that problem.
Just replace the Table on your Shopsmith
Strip Sander with this Sharpening Attachment,
switch to the angled Sharpening Platen, and
you’re ready to go, in less than two minutes!
Straight-edged chisels up to 1˝ wide and
curved-edge chisels of virtually any width, bend
or configuration can be sharpened in a flash.
Accepts chisels from 3˝ long to 26˝˝ long and
tilts from 90° to 0° to tackle steep-angle lathe
scraping tools or shallow angle carving sweeps.
Simply drop the butt-end of your chisel’s handle
into the special cup-shaped holder. Adjust for
the proper length, tilt the attachment to the
desired angle (matching existing angles is a
snap), tighten and sharpen.
Start by using a 150-grit belt to establish
your angle then work your way all the way up
to a 600-grit belt to achieve a super-sharp
“honed” edge, all without ever having to change
your set-up or sharpening angle.
Includes: Attachment, Platen, See-Thru
Upper Drum Belt Guard and Assorted Belt Kit
(one each 150, 220, 320, 400 and 600-grit
Aluminum Oxide belts).
❶
❷
❸
❹
❺
Lathe chisels are sharpened in a five step process, starting with the 150-grit belt and working up to the 600-grit belt.
Assorted Belt Kit
Note: Due to rotational direction, your Shopsmith
Strip Sander must be mounted to the Quill End
of your MARK V during operation.
This Attachment cannot be used with a Strip Sander
mounted on a Power Stand or Power Station.
555812 Shopsmith Strip
Sander Chisel
Sharpening Attachment
Includes Assorted Belt Kit (521897)
40
Chisel Sharpening
$104.58
The Strip Sander Sharpening Attachment comes
with the Aluminum Oxide Assorted Belt Kit.
521897 Assorted Belt Kit
$15.11
www.shopsmith.com
When you need unwavering accuracy and repeatability for making multiples,
these Incra , Accessories will meet your exacting requirements
®
• Quick, easy installation, silky-smooth operation and guaranteed perfect repeatability.
• Machine shop accuracy with instant adjustments
to .002˝, plus micro-adjustments to .001˝.
• 36˝ long fence remains perfectly parallel with
blade. It shifts off-center for additional infeed
or outfeed support and includes T-Slots for
attaching auxiliary shop-made faces, etc.
• 32˝ long stainless steel Scale provides direct
reading accuracy in 1/32˝ increments.
• Accepts the optional Wonder Fence.
See Below
Get matchless versatility, ease of use
and precision to .001˝ with Incra’s
TSIII Ultra Fence
Thanks to a special arrangement with Taylor
Design Group, Inc., manufacturer of the renowned
Incra® brand of power tool fence systems and
fixtures, Shopsmith now brings even more
versatility, accuracy and repeatability to your
MARK V than you ever dreamed possible!
The micro-adjustable TSIII Ultra Fence offers
machine shop accuracy, guaranteed perfect
repeatability, exceptional strength and quick,
simple installation.
Install it on your MARK V in about 15 minutes,
then remove or replace it in seconds. Use it for
precision ripping, dadoing, grooving, rabbeting or
molding operations. With the amazing TSIII Ultra
Fence on your team, you’ll build your projects
faster and virtually eliminate measurement errors.
Just flip the Quick Action Positioning Clamp
to slide the Fence Arm along its precision,
sawtooth racks for instant positioning to within
.002˝. Then, twist the Micro-Adjustment Knob
to zero-in to within an incredible .001˝! Change
set-ups, then return to previous settings with
ZERO repeatability errors and lightning speed!
Hi-RiseTM Fence
Cap for Vertical
Panel Raising
Dust Collection
Port
Two-Piece
Split Fence
36˝ Base Fence (Included with TSIII Ultra Fence)
Use the Wonder Fence for all your routing and
under-table shaping operations, including panel
raising, decorative edging, specialized joinery
cuts and lots more. Attach it to the TSIII Ultra
Fence System to get all the precision you could
want for producing perfect box joints, dovetails
or similar joinery cuts in an infinite variety of
styles and sizes.
1-800-543-7586
Each system comes complete with a comprehensive Owner’s Manual with detailed set-up
and operating instructions, a 40-minute VHS
set-up and operation Video and two five-foot
long MARK V Rail Connector Tubes.
$418.94
522143A TSIII Ultra Fence
Table
Not available for Model 500 See Pages 3 -7 for Model 500 Upgrades
The TSIII Ultra Fence is a Special Truck Shipment item and requires an
additional $10 shipping fee.
$107.40
522139 Pre-Drilled Floating
Table (Fits Models 505 & 510 –
Order The Ultimate Fence/Router
System Package and Save $38.64
Includes the TSIII Ultra Fence System, Wonder
Fence, a Shopsmith Router Table 555995- Pg. 46
the Shop Stop, the Right Angle Fixture, giant
Reference Guide and Dovetailing Video.
555935A Ultimate Fence/
$970.19
Router System Pkg.
For MARK V Models 505 & 510
$970.19
555934A Ultimate Fence/
Router System Pkg.
For MARK V Model 520
The Shopsmith Ultimate Fence/Router Package
is a Special Truck Shipment item and requires
an additional $20 shipping fee.
Required for Standard Model MARK V)
522373 Pre-Drilled Floating
$173.50
The Right
Angle Fixture
Table (Fits Model 520)
The Shop Stop
Repeat Positioner
Use it with your TSIII
Ultra Fence or the Wonder
Fence for instant, repeatable
accuracy without time-consuming set-ups. Reversible with an adjustable
Stop Bar and micro-adjustable Stop Rod. Usable
with zero-clearance wooden sub-fences.
522145A Shop Stop Positioner
$36.32
Hooks over
the top of your
Wonder Fence to
hold your stock
perfectly square
and provides rigid
back-up support
during joint-making or similar operations. Glides
smoothly and offers three T-Slots for the attachment of wooden faces to eliminate tear-out.
522146A Right Angle Fixture
$38.52
Improve the precision of all your routing and under-table shaping
operations with The Wonder Fence from Incra®
All critical Wonder Fence surfaces have been machined perfectly flat to ensure that both infeed and
outfeed fences remain perfectly perpendicular and parallel at all offset and gap settings.
Features
• The Wonder Fence attaches to the Shopsmith TSIII Ultra Fence System when performing
high-precision joinery or similar operations.
• Infeed and outfeed fences independently adjustable over a 1/8˝ offset range.
• Accommodates all router bits and shaper cutters, regardless of height.
• In-fence dust collection system attaches to industry standard hoses on the DC3300.
• Fence offset controllers are precision machined from solid blocks of aluminum. Each
includes its own cursor and laser engraved scale marked off in .002˝ increments.
• Hi-Rise Fence Cap makes easy work of panel raising and working with tall or wide boards.
• Accepts Right Angle Fixture and Shop Stop for added precision during crosscutting and end
grain operations, and ensured repeatability when routing or shaping multiples.
522144A Wonder Fence Router/Shaper Attachment
$220.49
TM
Incra’s® TSIII Ultra Fence System
41
Super-small to super-large – Incra’s MiterSled 5000 gives you optimal workpiece control
Whether it’s your basic 90° cut-off, simple picture frames, complex
compound miters, or a 20-sided object, the MiterSled 5000 delivers
perfect repeatable accuracy – the first time, every time and with any
angle. The precision angle indexing teeth allows 364 positive angle stops
in 1/2° increments over a full 90° range. It is continuously adjustable
between 1/2-degree steps.
Includes: The MiterSled 5000; 36˝ IncraLock Flip-Fence with Dual-Arm
Flip-Shop Stop Positioner telescopes to 64˝; Incra Protractor and 3-piece
MDF laminated Sled.
The MiterSled 5000 combines incremental angle control features with a
3-panel laminated Sled and, a longer fence for the ultimate miter cutting
workstation for your Shopsmith MARK V Models 505, 510 or 520/Pro
Fence table saw. The Sled consists of three laminated MDF panels with
two embedded aluminum T-tracks for securing an included workpiece
hold-down clamp. A renewable right panel provides zero clearance tearout control and cut-off support on both sides of the blade.
You get absolute rigid support for the 36˝ to 64˝ telescoping Incra LOCK
Cut-off Fence. You can crosscut a 25˝ wide board on your MARK V with
full control.
42
Incra® Miter Gauge/Miter Sled
Features
364 positive angle stops
1/2° increments
Special stops at 22 1/2° and 67 1/2°
GlideLOCK Miter Bar with 10 expansion points
AngleLOCK 36˝ IncraLOCK Flip-Shop Stop Fence telescopes to 64˝
INCRA FLIP Shop Stop Positioner 3-panel laminated SLED ... you’ll
easily achieve mitering accuracy you never thought possible.
$352.79
522163A Incra MiterSled 5000
•
•
•
•
•
•
Fits MARK V Models 505, 510 & Model 520/Pro Fence
The Incra MiterSled 5000 is a Special Truck Shipment item and requires
an additional $10 shipping fee.
www.shopsmith.com
Prefer Slot
Mortising?
See Page 45
Shopsmith’s Mortise &
Tenon Package
This package includes everything
in the Mortising Package described
to the left, PLUS, the Shopsmith Tenon
Master™ Jig. See Page 45
555845 Shopsmith Mortise
$272.66
& Tenon Package
YOU SAVE $20.10
Mortising Hold-Down
Attaches to the Rip Fence of your
MARK V (Model 500, 505, 510 or 520) to keep
your workpiece from lifting when the Bit/Chisel
set is withdrawn.
521900 Mortising Hold-Down
$43.35
Mortising Attachment
Attaches to your MARK V’s Quill to hold and
prevents the Mortising Chisel from turning while
the bit inside removes the majority of the stock
from the mortise.
521901 Mortising Attachment
$49.86
Drill perfectly square holes for mortise-and-tenon
joints, hinges and more with Shopsmith’s Hollow
Chisel Mortising Attachment
Several years ago, we discontinued the Hollow
Chisel Mortising Attachment that we had
offered for many years. This was due largely
to the fact that hollow chisel mortising was
fading in popularity ... as more and more
woodworkers were turning to slot mortising
with a router. As is the case, with many things
in life, this trend is now reversing itself as
hollow chisel mortising regains its popularity.
Fortunately, we held onto the tooling for this
once popular accessory and are now able to
bring it back, per your numerous requests.
The principle of this special tool is really
quite simple. Just install your Drill Chuck on
the MARK V spindle. Then, slip the Mortising
Attachment over the outside of the quill on
your MARK V, and tighten it in position with
a single 5/32˝ setscrew. Insert the Mortising
Chisel of your choice (1/4˝, 3/8˝ or 1/2˝) in the
other end of the attachment and tighten the
setscrew. Now, slip the appropriate Mortising
Bit up through the hollow chisel
and secure its shaft in your drill chuck.
The attachment holds the chisel (with
sharp honed edges) and keeps it from rotating,
while the special Mortising Bit inside turns. As
1-800-543-7586
Mortising Bit/Chisel Sets
Precision ground to produce sharp, clean
square holes and mortises.
you advance the quill, the rotating bit removes
the majority of the stock while the chisel’s
edges shave the sides of the mortise square
and smooth.
The special Hold-Down attaches to the top
of your MARK V’s rip fence to keep your workpiece from lifting when the chisel is withdrawn.
The Shopsmith Mortising Package
521882 1/4˝ Bit/Chisel Set
521883 3/8˝ Bit/Chisel Set
521884 1/2˝ Bit/Chisel Set
$28.27
$30.27
$32.37
Mortising Chisel Honing Stone
Hollow chisel mortising requires a great deal
of downward pressure to shave the sides of
the mortise smooth and true. That’s why it is
extremely important that all four edges of the
hollow chisel be kept as sharp as possible.
This precision-molded stone has been made
specifically for this purpose. The Mortising
Chisel Honing Stone is a 50-degree stone for
your 1/4˝, 3/8˝ and 1/2˝ chisel.
521902 Mortising Chisel Honing
$7.34
Stone
This package includes the Shopsmith Mortising
Attachment, Mortising Hold-Down, 1/4˝ Bit/
Chisel Set, 3/8˝ Bit/Chisel Set, 1/2˝ Bit/Chisel
Set and one Chisel Honing Stone.
555810 Shopsmith Mortising
$182.94
Package
(Works with MARK V Models 500, 505, 510 & 520)
YOU SAVE $7.99
513549 Mortising Chisel Honing
$5.93
Stone – Pre-1990
For 1/4 ˝ and 3/8 ˝ Mortising
Chisels – 41° Stone
513550 Mortising Chisel Honing
$3.97
Stone
Pre-1990. For 1/2 ˝ Mortising
Chisels – 46.5° Stone
Hollow Chisel Mortising
43
Join boards A better way with
Shopsmith’s Biscuit Joiner
Dadoing, Rabbeting, Dovetailing, Edging and Slot Mortising –
Just a few of the ways you’ll use our versatile Router Package
A
B
You’ll get tighter, stronger joints with the
Shopsmith Biscuit Joiner than you could ever
hope for with dowels and similar methods.
Just set your MARK V up in Drill Press mode,
attach the Biscuit Joiner and cut the small, halfoval slots in the edges of your mating boards.
Glue the special, football-shaped Biscuits into
the slots, clamp and allow to dry.
The highly compressed beechwood Biscuits
start swelling as soon as they contact the glue,
creating a super-tight fit that locks the joined
boards together – permanently.
A simple setting lets you control the depthof-cut for the three different-sized biscuits.
Workpiece alignment is assured by the Biscuit’s
uniform shape and size ... and by the precision
of the slots cut by the Joiner.
You can even slide the mating boards backand-forth to make lateral adjustments.
555320 Shopsmith Biscuit
$146.48
Joiner
(Includes Carbide-Tipped Cutting Blade,
Non-Slip Surfaces, Instruction Manual
and 25 #20 Biscuits)
Replacement Non-Slip Pads
Pair of adhesive-backed Pads attach to Joiner
face to stop creeping during operation (pair).
516348 Non-Slip Joiner Pads
$5.31
A biscuit size for every job
Biscuits are 5/32˝ thick, compressed beechwood.
Three different sizes are available. Packaged
100 per bag.
#20 Biscuits – 2 5/8˝ x 1˝
For larger projects and those under the
greatest stress.
710203 #20 Biscuits
$10.49
#10 Biscuits – 21/8˝ x 3/4˝
For joinery on all types of projects.
710205 #10 Biscuits
$10.49
#0 Biscuits – 1 /4˝ x 5/8˝
For joining smaller projects and edge-to-edge
applications with no high stress anticipated.
710206 #0 Biscuits
$10.49
3
44
Joinery/Routing
C
D
E
F
G
Experienced woodworkers know the router is
one of the most versatile of all power tools. Use
it to create a variety of strong, attractive joints
like sliding dovetails, rabbets and dadoes; to
hollow-out boxes, trays and similar projects; to
add decorative edges to furniture or architectural
moldings; even to create freehand designs for signs,
wall plaques and crafts projects of all types.
With a few limitations, the Shopsmith Router
Package will perform all of these operations. It
just does them a bit differently. First of all, it’s
used with the MARK V in the Drill Press mode
of operation.
The 1/2˝ shaft Carbide-Tipped Router Bits
slip into a special 1/2˝ Router Chuck, which
attaches directly to the MARK V Spindle. The
moving Bit remains in the same place while the
workpiece is moved through the cut.
When Routing with this MARK V setup, you’ll
enjoy a much better view of the work in progress
than with a hand-held router or router table.
A see-through Shield protects your eyes from
flying dust and chips and keeps your fingers
out of harm’s way.
Plus, with this setup, you’ll also be able to
use your MARK V’s Rip Fence and Miter Gauge
when performing repetitive cuts with or across
the grain.
The Shopsmith Router Package includes:
(555191) 1/2˝ Router Chuck with Shield plus
five Carbide-Tipped, 1/2˝ shank Router Bits
(521866, 521867, 521868, 521869, 521870)
555176 Router Package
$115.49
YOU SAVE $18.70
Router Chuck and Shield
A. The Shopsmith Router Chuck has been
engineered to withstand the side thrust that’s
typical with routing operations. Side thrust
operations will damage Geared Chucks.
Two Chucks are available to accept either
1/2˝ or 1/4˝ shank bits. Both models attach
directly to your MARK V’s 5/8˝ Spindle.
B. The Clear Shield clamps around the MARK
V Quill with a single setscrew and provides
both front eye protection and a rear brush
that can be adjusted to meet the top of your
workpiece, the MARK V Rip Fence or the
Shopsmith Shaper/Drum Sander Fence for
added dust collection efficiency.
555191 1/2˝ Chuck with Shield
$38.08
555189 1/4˝ Chuck with Shield
$38.08
514631 1/2˝ Router Chuck (only)
$18.98
514632 1/4˝ Router Chuck (only)
$18.98
Carbide-Tipped Router Bits
These rugged Bits have been designed to
provide durable, smooth-cutting service when
working with hardwoods, softwoods or tough
laminates in either a home shop or production
environment. All feature 1/2 ˝ shanks for use
with the Shopsmith Router Chuck.
C. 521870 3/4˝ Straight Bit
$20.04
D. 521869 1/2˝ Straight Bit
$18.99
E. 521868 3/8˝ Straight Bit
$17.94
F. 521867 1/4˝ Straight Bit
$17.94
G. 521866 1/2˝ Dovetail Bit
$21.20
www.shopsmith.com
Mortise and Tenon Joint Basics
The mortise-and-tenon is one of the strongest
joints in woodworking ... and the recent popularity of arts-and-crafts (mission) furniture has
also made it one of the most popular.
Proportions: Tenons are usually 1/3 the thickness
of the mating stock and centered. 3/4˝ stock =
1/4˝ tenon. The mortise should be about 3/4˝
the width of the mating stock. For blind joints,
the tenon should be a bit shorter than the
mortise depth, to allow room for glue.
4˝ wide stock = 17/16˝ long tenon.
Which first – mortise or tenon? The
mortise should always be cut first, because
it’s far easier to shave tenon dimensions than
it is to enlarge mortises.
Which mortising method? Slot mortises
are created by drilling or routing, then sized
and squared with a chisel. Hollow chisel mortises are created by a square, tubular chisel
with a drill bit inside. This method is faster and
requires less sizing and squaring.
Which tenoning method? Tenons can
be formed by making repetitive Dado blade
passes with the stock laying flat on the work
table surface – or by making (usually) six cuts
with a regular saw blade and a tenoning jig that
lets you stand the stock “on end” to cut the
broad sides of the tenon’s cheeks. Routers can
also cut tenons, using special jigs.
Quick-release Toggle Clamp
Assembly is the perfect
workpiece gripper for fixtures
Perfect for use with all types of jigs and fixtures
in the shop. A quick flip of the lever clamps the
adjustable, rubber foot firmly onto the surface
of your stock. Includes four mounting screws.
555094 Toggle Clamp Assembly
Creating the eight most common types of mortise-and-tenon
joints is easy with Shopsmith’s Mortising accessories
$17.99
Shaper/Router
Guard Upgrades
B
C
A
A. Cut perfect tenons every time with the
Tenon Master Jig
The Shopsmith Tenon Master ™ Jig was
designed with a wide, flat face that holds
workpieces exactly perpendicular to the
work table top. It is used primarily with the
table saw for creating tenons on the ends
of boards ... but is equally useful for holding
and guiding workpieces through all types of
operations on other tools.
™
Made of cast aluminum, it offers a large
comfortable knob for optimum control and
a built-in miter bar that fits your MARK V,
Band-saw or Belt Sander Miter Gauge slot
perfectly.
A toggle clamp is included to help you grip
the workpiece, as is an arced wooden trunnion to provide back-up support when cutting stock with angled ends. For example,
when cutting spline grooves in the mating
faces of miters.
A very versatile accessory with numerous
work-saving/precision-enhancing applications.
1-800-543-7586
Through
Three-way
Loose Wedge
Keyed
Haunched
Blind
Twin
Cogged
Shaper/Router Guard Retro-Fit Kit
delivers added safety and dust
collection efficiency
Includes Toggle Clamp, wooden Angle trunnion and complete instructions.
555479 Tenon Master ™ Jig
$117.90
B. Slot Mortising Package teams the Tenon
Master ™ Jig with Shopsmith’s Router
Chuck, Bits and Shield
This package includes Shopsmith’s 1/4˝, 3/8˝
and 1/2˝ Carbide-Tipped straight
(1/2 shank) Router Bits; the Shopsmith
Router Chuck with Shield; and Shopsmith’s
Tenon Master ™ Jig.
555372 Slot Mortising Pkg.
$188.61
YOU SAVE $11.64
Upgrades Shaper/Router Kits purchased
prior to 1/86
This special Kit includes a clear, see-through
Shaper/Router Guard Shield; a Shaper/ Drum
Sander Vacuum Attachment (C); a quill-mounted
Featherguard Hold-Down; rear Fence Guard;
Featherboard; plus all mounting hardware.
555140 Shaper/Router Guard
$54.30
Retro-Fit Kit
C. Shaper/Drum Sander Vacuum Attachment
captures sawdust and debris at the source
Attaches to the underside of the Shaper/Drum
Sander Table Insert on MARK V Models 500,
505, 510 and 520.
555168 Shaper/Drum Sander
$11.76
Vacuum Attachment
Prefer Chisel
Mortising?
See Page 43
✍
The Shopsmith MARK V is essential for
so many things I do – whether it’s a
handyman project, hobby or furniture making.
~ P. Thorell, Sun City West, AZ
Routing/Slot Mortising
45
Enjoy unrivaled precision and dust collection efficiency with our
micro-adjustable, two-piece Pro Fence Router Table System
Optional Accessories
F
C
A
E
D
B
A. Router Table Guard – Use when freehand
routing or using bits with bearing pilots.
Includes: See-through Guard, screw-in
mounting post and bracket and integral,
dust port.
515704 Router Guard
$66.14
B. Router Table Featherboards – Attach
Table Surface
Accepting virtually any hand-held router motor,
it can be used as a “floating table” between
your MARK V’s Work Table and Extension Table,
or as an outboard unit, supported by your
Extension Table and Telescoping Legs.
Made of 11/4˝ thick double-refined MDF
(medium density fiberboard), all surfaces are
laminate-covered for durability and smoothgliding action.
Mounting Plate
The patented Woodhaven
Mounting Plate comes
with a blank insert, a
2˝ hole insert, a 1˝ hole insert with a 1 3/16˝ diameter bushing counterbore, a 1/2˝ diameter nylon
starting pin, and complete with instructions and
mounting hole diagrams for 37 popular router
motors.
The Plate is supported by four, Woodhaven
Stay-True Plate Levelers™ that can be adjusted
to provide snag-free gliding action.
46
Adjustable Fences
Each of the two rugged, extruded aluminum
Fences mount quickly and independently with
twin knobs to the T-Track in the top of your
Pro Fence System Rip Fence.
Each Fence offers more than enough left/
right travel providing the ideal bit clearance for
optimal workpiece support ... whether you’re
working with a 1/8˝ diameter straight bit or a
giant, 3˝ or larger diameter panel-raising bit.
The in-out position of each fence half is
controlled by turning a large, four-wing adjustment knob. Each 1/4-turn provides a
precise, 1/128˝ of micro-adjustment.
A shatter resistant, see-through upper
guard provides eye protection and helps
seal off the gap between
the two fences for added dust collection efficiency.
Connect the vacuum port on either
half of the fence to a 21/2˝ diameter
hose for super-efficient dust collection. A 21/2˝
elbow is included (and required) for attaching
the hose to either of these ports.
555865 Pro Fence Router
$539.99
Table System
555995 Router Table
$345.65
521963 Router Fence
$304.88
Pro Fence Router Table System
to threaded inserts in Table surface to
hold stock against Fences during straight
line routing.
Includes: (2) Featherboards, (4) knobs
and (4) washers.
555878 Featherboards
$26.06
C. On-Off Switch – Attach to the underside of
your Router Table and then plug your router
motor into it. Eliminates fumbling for your
router motor’s switch during operations.
$44.74
555877 On-Off Switch
D. Rip-Fence Featherboard – Attaches to the
top of your Router Table Fence for use as
a hold-down during straight-line routing.
$22.55
555783 Rip-Fence
Featherboard
E. Dust Collection Elbow – 21/2˝ Elbow allows
you to attach a DC3300 Dust Collection
Hose to each end of your Router Table’s
Fences for even greater efficiency.
514521 21/2˝ Elbow
$7.39
F. Fence Light Kit – Includes a Shopsmith
Utility Light (555503) and special bracket
for mounting to the T-Track in the top
surface of Router Table Fences.
$71.30
555806 Light w/Bracket
$22.22
521787 Bracket only
www.shopsmith.com
Full-featured Router Table Kit fits
on the end of your MARK V
Enjoy super-smooth cuts and long-lasting
durability with these premium-quality
Shopsmith Carbide Router Bits
Routing is an accurate way to cut, shape, mold,
mortise, duplicate and form intricate, professional-looking joinery. Made of tough carbide to
Shopsmith’s specifications, the bits are designed
to hold their razor-sharp edges up to 10 times
longer than high-speed steel bits. It’s best to
make several light passes through the wood.
One deep cut could splinter the wood at the
end of a cross-grain cut. If possible, leave extra
A
Just drop the twin Mounting tubes into the
Extension Table mounts on your MARK V, install
and adjust the single Telescoping Leg on the
opposite side and you have the foundation for
a great Router Table.
The 23 3/4˝ x 18˝ laminate-covered table top
features a drop-in center insert (with leveling
shims), to which you attach your router motor’s
base. Its inlaid aluminum T-Slot miter gauge
channel will accept the MARK V Miter Gauge
or Featherboards and can be easily adjusted
for a snug fit.
A series of threaded inserts in the table’s
surface accept the independently adjustable
two-piece Fence which can be locked into
position with comfortable 3-wing knobs. Travel
slots in the Fence faces allow the attachment
of shop-made faces.
The Router Guard offers a large 2 1/2˝ dust
collection port on top and an adjustable brush
on the back side to contain and direct dust
and debris.
The large table surface also makes an
excellent auxiliary support table for other
MARK V operations. Includes the Router Table,
Extension Table Base, one Telescoping Support
Leg, Router Guard (with built-in dust pickup),
Guard Support Assembly and Fences. Can also
be mounted on the Power Station.
The MARK V Router Table requires a separate
router motor. The router motor must not exceed
3 hp. The router base must be round and not
exceed 61/2˝ in diameter.
555658 Router Table Kit
$285.37
Router Table Upgrade
Retro-Fit Router Table Fence
and Hardware
Standard on Routing Systems purchased after
8/28/89. Includes Fence, Hardware and Knobs.
515511 Adjustable Fence
$36.76
and Hardware
1-800-543-7586
B
C
D
E
A. “3-in-1” Router Bit routs out plates,
trays or boxes
Cuts a straight side up to 11/4˝ deep with
a radius of 1/8˝ and 7/16˝ width. Makes
smooth rounded corners, and shapes a
perfectly flat bottom – all in a single pass!
Finest industrial grade, high-speed carbide.
$23.29
$27.59
$28.69
C. Chamfer
555234 45° Chamfer
$20.99
H
I
J
We include shims to assure perfect alignment.
Recommended for use on 3/4˝ stock.
11/2˝ diameter x 3˝ long.
555380 Reversible Stile
$69.59
and Rail Bit
(1/2-inch Shank)
555231 5/32˝ Roman Ogee
555229 1/4˝ Round Over
555223 3/8˝ Round Over
555244 1/2˝ Round Over
$29.79
$27.59
$33.09
E. Dovetail
555235 3/8˝ – 9° Cutting
$8.79
Angle
555237 1/2˝ – 14° Cutting
Angle
$9.99
F. Reversible Stile and Rail Bit does the job
of two separate bits
Cuts both the stile and rail pieces for door
panel framework. Match up stile cuts with
rail cuts by removing the locking nut and
changing the profiling cutters and bearing.
$25.39
$30.89
$33.09
I. Slot Cutter & Rabbeting
555246 1/4˝ Slot Cutter
555233 3/8˝ Rabbeting
D. Cove
555228 1/4˝ Cove
555224 1/2˝ Cove
G
H. Round Over
B. Beading
555230 1/4 ˝ Beading
555238 3/8 ˝ Beading
F
G. Roman Ogee
All bits have 1/4 ˝ shank
555407 3-in-1 Router Bit
stock on the workpiece so any splintered area
can be cut away. Making all cross-grain cuts
first helps avoid splinter problems. Work the
wood at an even steady pace. Too slow, the
wood will burn – too fast and the motor will
labor and the cut will not be smooth. All of
these Bits feature 1/4˝ shanks and are designed
for use with the (514632) Shopsmith 1/4˝
Router Chuck. See Page 44
$18.79
$20.99
J. Straight
555222
555277
555232
555236
1/4˝ Straight
3/8˝ Straight
1/2˝ Straight
3/4˝ Straight
$12.19
$12.19
$13.19
$13.19
“T-Slot” Bit cuts keyhole-shaped slot
for hanging plaques/frames
Cuts a slot that lets the head of a screw or nail
slip into the bottom or one side and slide along
a 1/4˝ slot. Forms a 1/4˝ wide slot and a 3/8˝
diameter keyhole. Cuts up to 5/8˝ deep.
Carbide tipped.
555406 T-Slot Router Bit
Carbide Router Bits
$19.79
47
The Shopsmith Overarm Pin Router
Here’s what you’ll get:
Overarm, Mounting Clamps,
Work Table, (2) Table Inserts
(one for conventional routing and one for pin routing),
(3) Guide/Starter Pins, Twopiece Fence with Mounting Knobs, Safety Shield, Dust Port,
Mounting Hardware and Manual.
Rout exact
duplicates
the fast,
easy way!
•
•
•
•
Now, you can turn your hand-held router into one
of the most versatile tools in your workshop
You’ll be amazed how often you’ll
reach for this incredible tool!
Originally offered as a free-standing model in
the 1980’s, the Shopsmith Overarm Pin Router
has been recently re-designed for easy mounting
to your MARK V in a matter of seconds.
Just mount the Overarm and Router Table
directly to your MARK V’s twin Way Tubes and
Work Table and in minutes, you’ll be performing many operations faster and with far greater
precision and repeatability than you could hope
to achieve with conventional routing methods.
You’ll do all this with your
Overarm Router:
• Form decorative edges and surface
designs on straight or curved stock.
• Cut precision
dadoes, rabbets,
sliding dovetails,
drop-leaves and
similar joints.
safe view of your work at all times ... and be
able to make depth-of-cut adjustments with a
simple drill press-like quill lever.
So … what exactly is Pin Routing?
It’s a simple operation that uses a shop-built
guiding fixture to make exact duplicates of
workpieces, just like they’ve done in cabinet
shops and furniture factories for years.
Here’s how the Pin Routing
process works:
• A particleboard or MDF fixture is made by
cutting grooves in one side, matching the
shape of the pieces you want to make.
• A straight bit is inserted into the router
motor (mounted in the Overarm).
• A tracing pin (same size as the groove in
your fixture – and your bit) is inserted into
the Table Plate. The pin and bit are then
aligned perfectly with one another.
• A workpiece is temporarily screwed to
Cutting drop-leaf
* Round motors only.
And, since it operates with the bit cutting down
from above the workpiece, you’ll have a clear
** With 3 1/2 ˝ diameter Router Motor. Distances vary, depending on
diameter of router motor.
Pin Routing
Feature-packed for top performance
Your Overarm Pin Router is loaded with features
and capabilities that will help you turn out better
projects every time.
• The rigid, cast aluminum Arm will not flex
during operation.
• A large Work Table with a friction-free,
laminate-covered surface delivers smooth
operation and optimal support.
• Precision, rack-and-pinion Quill Feed mechanism makes minute adjustments a snap.
• Shatterproof, see-through Safety Guard
keeps your fingers out of harm’s way.
• Built-in Dust Chute catches debris at
its source.
• Comprehensive Owner’s Manual guides
you through set-up and all operations.
555970 Overarm Pin Router
$485.99
with standard accessories
Single Support Leg required for
Model 500 units (555627) See Page 30
SPECIFICATIONS
• Repair furniture
and veneers.
• Joint workpiece
edges for glue-ups.
• “Saw” straight and
Duplicating a plaque
irregular shapes.
• “Drill” round or oddly-shaped holes.
• Pin rout exact duplicate workpieces.
48
(or clamped into) the opposite side of the
grooved fixture.
The fixture is then flipped over (with the
workpiece attached) and its groove dropped
over the tracing pin.
The router motor is turned on and the bit
lowered into the stock. The groove is traced
over the pin, creating a workpiece that
matches the size and shape of the groove
in your fixture, perfectly.
The workpiece is removed and replaced with
a new blank ... then the process is repeated,
if desired.
Once you’ve made a fixture, cut out as many
parts as you like, then set it aside until the
next time you want to make more of the
same item.
Maximum router motor HP......................... 3 hp
Router motor diameters accepted* ...... 21/2˝ to 4˝
Throat depth ............................. 101/2˝ to 181/2˝†
(bit center to Way Tubes)**
Vertical motor travel (lever-controlled) .........3 1/2˝
Maximum workpiece thickness ......Approx. 11˝‡
Fence size (2) ............................ 131/4˝w x 11/4˝h
Work Table size ............181/2 ˝ d x 28˝ w x 3/4˝ h
(laminate-covered MDF)
Guide/Starter pin......................1/4˝, 3/8˝ & 1/2˝
diameters furnished
Maximum bit diameter (with insert) .............13/8˝
Maximum bit diameter (without insert) ............2˝
Dust port diameter .....................................21/4˝
† Maximum dimensions, depending on which set of Arm mounting
holes are used.
‡ Varies, based on router motor and bit used.
www.shopsmith.com
Your guide to maximum MARK V performance
This section of the Shopsmith Catalog is devoted to helping you keep
your MARK V and Special Purpose Tools operating at their peak. The
easiest and best way for you to ensure that your machines are performing
up to standards is to follow the guidelines for periodic maintenance in
your Owner’s Manuals. Doing this will help you avoid most of the problems
which might occur.
In those rare instances when you may need to purchase a replacement
part (usually at the recommendation of our Technical Services Staff), this
special Parts Price List will help you identify the items you need and provide
their part numbers and current prices.
It is important that you follow the Periodic Maintenance Schedule in
your MARK V manual. We’ve also included a table here that describes
the ten most common problems encountered by MARK V users – and
their remedies. If you have a problem with your MARK V, look to this
table (or the Troubleshooting Chart in your Owner’s Manual) first for
the solution. If you are unable to find the solution you need here, just
call our TOLL-FREE Technical Services Hotline at 1-800-762-7555 for
the answers you need.
10 most common MARK V problems and their remedies
➀ Machine bogs down when ripping ...............................................Re-tension the Poly-V Belt to have no less than 1/8 deflection.
➁ Circuit breaker blows when you turn machine on ...................Check to see if you turned off your machine on high speed. If so, unplug your machine and install
➂
➃
➄
➅
➆
➇
➈
➉
............................................................................................................the sanding disc. Rotate the disc counter-clockwise, by hand, while turning the speed dial to slow.
Speed dial is difficult to turn ........................................................Oil sheaves. Check speed control quadrant assembly for lubrication.
Nothing happens when turning machine on ..............................Check for loose wires. Replace switch, if necessary.
Depth control dial won’t lock .......................................................Check serrated washers. Clean with wire brush or replace.
Bit drills deeper than setting on depth dial ...............................Check quill spring housing to see if spring has slipped. Make sure indentation on quill spring housing
............................................................................................................aligns with setscrew used to lock housing in place.
Headstock is difficult to slide on way tubes ..............................Wax (or rotate) way tubes.
Saw blade hits table insert when tilting table to 45° ...............Extend the quill to achieve necessary clearance.
Sandpaper difficult to remove from disc ....................................Heat in oven, with iron, or with heat gun to soften glue.
Headstock lock squeaks when tightening ...................................Clean threaded rod with wire brush, then lubricate with powdered graphite.
IMPORTANT NOTE: The exploded views and listings of parts presented here are for the most recent models of Shopsmith equipment. If you have difficulty locating the part you need on
any of the drawings, or find that the part number is not listed, you own an earlier model machine. Call our Technical Services Hotline, TOLL-FREE at 1-800-762-7555 for assistance.
The 17 Most Frequently Ordered Shopsmith MARK V Service Parts
G. Speed Control Assembly
A
C
B
D
H
E
F
I
G
J
N
K
L
A. DC3300 Dust Collector Fan
May require replacement if your
DC3300 seems to lack sufficient
power to pick up. A roaring noise
indicates that replacement is required.
515287
$34.00
B. Gilmer Belt – May require replace-
ment if your MARK V bogs down
during use, or if your belt is frayed
or broken. Contact Shopsmith
Customer Service for belt tensioning instructions prior to replacement.
521683
$31.99
C. Motor Drive Belt – May require
replacement if your MARK V is
vibrating excessively, or the belt
is frayed or broken.
521682
$19.99
O
H.
M
P
Q
I.
D. Poly-V-Belt – May require
E.
F.
replacement if your MARK V bogs
down during use, or if your belt is
frayed or broken. Contact Shopsmith
Customer Service for belt tensioning
instructions prior to replacement.
$22.80
521681
Replacement Caster Wheel
Use these to replace the worn-out
wheels on your Shopsmith casters.
522215
$3.59
Jointer Fence Tilt Quadrant
May require replacement if the
outfeed end of the jointer fence
raises too high off the outfeed table
surface, or if the fence lock handle
fails to hold the fence at the proper
angle when tightened.
502651
$38.32
J.
K.
L.
Includes all the parts required for
repairing speed changing problems.
An assembly for those customers who
prefer to replace the entire assembly instead of the individual parts.
$54.80
504198
Quadrant Assembly
This small, “pork-chop” shaped
piece, with teeth on the back side
of the speed dial, may need to be
replaced if your MARK V’s speed
fails to increase when turning dial.
$22.43
504221
Control Sheave Assembly
May require replacement in the
event the bearing gets clogged
and ceases to turn, or if the snapon rectangular retaining loop pulls
off the end of the control sheave.
515556
$49.26
Help Kit Hardware Pack
Be prepared – order this collection of 57 assorted setscrews and
shims for your MARK V and other
Shopsmith accessories.
$24.72
515714
Locking Toggle Switch
$30.87
522384
Older Style Toggle Switch
$27.80
515605
M. Quill Feed Handle Assembly
Comes complete with hub.
$14.90
513682
Have a Service Question? Call 1-800-762-7555
Headstock Lock and Wedges
These may require replacement if the
MARK V headstock lock fails to turn,
yet the headstock still slides on the
way tubes; or if the lock is loosened,
yet the head stock fails to slide. Order
all three part numbers for the most
effective repair.
N. Lock – Includes the headstock
Lock handle and threaded connecting rod for the two wedges.
$17.57
513014
O. Left-Hand Wedge
P.
504234
$8.95
Right-Hand Wedge
504235
$8.95
Q. Speed Control Handle – The
portion of the speed dial that is
turned with the fingers. Replace
it if the machine speed changes
while the speed dial remains at
the same setting.
504229
$29.52
Parts List Index
Bandsaw...............................56-58
Belt Sander...........................60-61
Dust Collector ........................... 63
Jointer........................................ 62
Planers..................................64-66
Scroll Saws...........................58-59
Shopsmith MARK V .............50-56
Strip Sander .............................. 60
Service Parts
49
MARK V
Bench & Base Assembly
Head Stock Assembly
(Model 505/510/520)
(Model 505/510/520)
Ref.
No.
Part No.
—
—
1
2
3
4
5
—
6
8
9
—
513618
504144
518379
504293
504146
120382
138245
504148
504158
504161
504153
501286
Description
Qty.
Bench Assembly (incl. 1-19, 21-23)
Base Assembly (incl. 1-5)
Base
1
Arm Lock Knob
1
Tube Lock Bar
1
Washer
2
Hex Bolt
2
Headrest Assembly (incl. 6-18)
Lock Shaft
1
Lock Spring
1
Hex Socket Setscrew
1
Accessory Mount Lock
Assembly (incl. 10-12 or 21-23)
10
†
Left-Hand Stud
1
11
†
Sleeve and Insert Assembly
1
12
†
Right-Hand Stud
1
13
517768
Headrest
1
14
504157
Cam Pin
1
15
5041569
Headrest Handle
1
16
504146
Tube Lock Bar
1
17
120382
Washer
2
18
138245
Hex Bolt
2
19
504163
Bench Tube
2
20
501193
Way Tube
2
21
†
Right-Hand Stud
1
22
†
Sleeve and Insert Assembly
1
23
†
Left-Hand Stud
1
24
518381
Base Arm
1
25
50426401
Way Tube Tie Bar (incl. 26)
1
26
502051
Cup Point Setscrew
2
27
502051
Cup Point Setscrew
2
28
517642
Retaining Ring
2
29
518378
Base Arm Pin
1
30
50416201
Leg
2
—
522063
505/510/520 Hardware Pack
1
—
522064
Hex Wrench Pack
1
31
518114
Truss Head Screw
10
32
115546
Lock Washer
10
33
120372
Square Nut
10
† Not available as a service part.
Price
Each
$442.23
65.33
51.50
3.74
5.09
0.80
0.80
137.99
4.66
0.80
1.36
17.55
87.30
6.91
8.78
5.09
0.80
0.80
57.25
73.20
60.47
15.54
0.80
0.80
0.80
7.89
60.75
6.91
8.75
0.80
0.68
$0.80
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
522400
—
522399
—
522404
Headstock Assembly,
1,604.24
60 hz. 120 Volt, Domestic (incl. 34-135)
Headstock Assembly,
1,660.49
60 hz. 240 Volt, Domestic (incl. 34-135)
Headstock Assembly,
1,716.74
50 hz. 240 Volt, European (incl. 34-135)
Quill Feed Assembly (incl. 34-43)
100.22
Feed Stop
1
15.83
Feed Stop Handle
1
9.21
Serrated Washer
2
2.58
Washer
1
1.78
Retaining Ring
1
0.80
Drive Screw
1
0.80
Woodruff Key
1
0.80
Quill Feed Pinion
1
36.27
Setscrew
1
2.59
Allen Setscrew
1
0.80
Logo Cover
1
30.56
Pivot Pin
1
0.92
Screw, Phillips Head, 8-32 x 3/8˝
1
0.80
Push Nut
1
0.80
Machine Screw, 5/16˝ x 1-3/4˝
1
0.80
Pan Head Screw
2
0.80
Washer
2
0.80
Right-Hand Wedge Lock
1
5.24
Left-Hand Wedge Lock
1
5.24
Wire Retaining Clip
1
1.11
Spherical Washer
1
1.49
Retaining Ring
1
4.34
Poly V-Belt
1
22.80
Drive Sleeve Assembly (incl. 57)
1
101.27
Drive and Ring Assembly
1
7.64
Retaining Ring
1
1.45
Quill Assembly (incl. 59-66)
149.29
Quill Housing
1
Quill Bumper Ring
1
0.80
Retaining Ring
1
1.08
—
34
35
36
37
38
41
42
43
44
45
46
46A
46B
46C
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
—
59
60
61
504171
5013149
5041729
501311
501627
501626
145378
110731
501312
501634
513056
51372304
516531
449613
516536
516895
448027
501630
504234
504235
514779
501317
501299
521681
518145
514083
501621
518210
†
501307
501624
Qty.
Price
Each
(Continued on next page)
50
Parts Price List
www.shopsmith.com
MARK V
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
62
64
65
66
67
†
†
†
102581
522382
Spindle Assembly
Retaining Ring
Spindle Knob
Allen Setscrew
Headstock Housing Assembly
(Incl. 46-46C, 52, 68, 99,
103A, 130-133, 189)
Speed Chart Label
Washer
Hex Nut
Tinnerman Clip
Spring
Quill Feed Sleeve
Washer
Quill Lock Handle
Speed Control Dial
Headstock Lock Assm. (incl.78-80)
Headstock Lock
Rollpin
Rod
Shakeproof Lock Washer
Screw
Dial Spring
Speed Control Handle (incl. 85)
Allen Setscrew
Speed Control Assm. (incl. 86-96)
Quadrant Assembly
Worm Control Shaft
Rollpin
Speed Control Bracket
Spring Washer
Washer
Retaining Ring
Idler Gear
Setscrew
Idler Bushing
Jam Nut
Pan Head Screw
Belt Cover (incl. 98-102)
Belt Cover, 240 Volt
Belt Cover, Canadian
Belt Cover (incl. 99)
Shaft Guard Cover
Warning Label
Spring Flat Nut
Vent Plate
Roundhead Machine Screw
Eccentric Bushing Assembly
(incl. 103-104)
Eccentric Bushing Mach.
Washer
Screw, #6-32 x 3/8˝ Hex Washer Hd.
Idler Shaft Assembly
(incl. 105-112)
Idler Shaft
Retaining Ring
Sheave Clip
Short Key
Idler Sheave
Control Sheave Assembly
(incl. 110-112)
Control Sheave
Retaining Loop
Rollpin
68
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
—
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
—
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
—
—
—
98
98A
99
100
101
102
—
516627
120379
102634
501656
504196
501318
501631
5041769
5042259
513014
†
†
†
115545
448027
504228
504229
145709
504198
504221
504216
457008
513700
513089
501640
504217
504220
51398905
504219
124818
513608
521944
522403
522402
522130
555894
516626
445124
514471
132696
515616
103
103A
104
—
†
501616
515615
504177
105
106
107
108
109
—
5041789
504179
504189
501320
5041809
515556
110
111
112
†
504187
513734
1-800-543-7586
Qty.
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
7
1
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Price
Each
$0.80
269.66
3.25
0.80
0.80
0.80
1.94
4.57
1.27
9.34
17.03
17.57
0.80
0.80
0.80
29.52
0.80
54.80
22.43
5.33
0.80
24.36
0.80
0.80
0.80
2.85
0.80
1.01
0.80
0.80
74.57
102.95
96.20
72.87
7.62
4.80
0.80
2.85
0.80
27.29
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
113
—
521682
504194
—
513617
—
516152
—
513614
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
—
501645
504553
509226
504208
513056
504207
504209
513964
—
513968
Drive Belt
Motor Pan Assembly,
120 Volt (incl. 114-129)
Motor Pan Assembly,
240 Volt (incl. 114-129)
Motor and Sheave Assembly,
120 Volt (incl. 114-124)
Motor and Sheave Assembly,
240 Volt (incl. 114-124)
Retaining Ring
Washer
Motor Spring
Floating Sheave
Cup Point Setscrew
Fan Sheave
Long Key
Motor Assembly,
60 hz, 120 Volt (incl. 121, 122-124)
Motor Assembly,
50/60 hz, 240 Volt (incl. 121A-124)
Motor (120 Volt)
Motor (240 Volt)
Drive Screw
Motor Fan Plate
Sheave Spacer
Wire Tie
Power Cord
Strain Relief
Motor Pan
Pan Head Sems Screw
Switch Serv Pack
(incl. 130, 130A, 132, 133)
Locking Toggle Switch Assm.
Switch Key
Hex Wshr Hd. Mach Srw #8-32 x 3/8˝
Jumper Wire, white
Connector Wire, black
Lever and Hub Assembly
(incl.134-135)
Quill Feed Hub
Quill Feed Handle
121
121A
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
—
†
†
†
†
†
518679
518242
513740
50421201
515426
522384
130
130A
131
132
133
—
†
515107
517328
518302
518303
513682
134
135
5041739
513017
Qty.
1
Price
Each
$19.99
499.65
542.69
423.48
455.21
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0.80
0.93
4.35
32.75
0.80
26.69
1.35
358.18
392.79
1
1
5
1
1
2
1
1
1
4
1
1
1
1
2
0.80
26.17
0.80
52.70
0.80
34.87
2.67
0.80
3.02
3.02
14.90
1
1
8.42
6.13
Tips & Techniques
0.80
0.80
110.88
34.99
0.80
0.80
1.46
30.11
49.26
1.62
0.80
• Never wear jewelry when operating woodworking
machinery.
• Be sure there are no loose straps or strings on your
clothing.
• Always roll up your sleeves above your elbows.
• Always wear safety glasses.
• Never wear gloves when working on machinery.
• Rubber-soled leather shoes provide the best protection and highest resistance to slippage.
Parts Price List
51
MARK V
Ref.
No.
Part No.
—
167
168
169
170
171
—
514328
514209
504259
514329
514211
120396
514330
Carriage Assembly
Upper & Lower Saw Guards
(Model 505/510/520)
(Model 505/510/520)
Description
Carriage Assembly (incl. 167-188)
Carriage
Retaining Washer
Pinion Shaft
Table Elevating Pinion
Washer
Table Height Crank Assembly
(incl. 172-174)
172
514334
Crank and Insert
173
513418
Handle Shaft
174
513417
Crank Handle
175
120388
Washer
176
5042629
Table Height Lock
—
514335
Carriage Lock Assembly
(incl. 177-188)
177
443334
Flexloc Nut
178
514237
Washer
179
514095
Wedge Lock
180
†
Spring
183
514336
Shaft
184
514526
Cam
185
514527
Rollpin
186
514096
Cam Wedge
187
514126
Carriage Lock Handle
188
455734
Rollpin
189
516667
Carriage Stop Ring
†Not available as a service part.
Qty.
1
1
1
2
1
Price
Each
$178.46
82.18
0.85
9.12
8.37
0.80
22.23
1
1
1
1
1
16.17
4.10
2.06
0.80
7.82
43.14
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1.25
0.80
3.36
7.83
5.40
0.80
6.30
9.77
0.80
1.88
Tips & Techniques
• Regular maintenance is essential for any machine to
perform at its best. Follow the maintenance schedule in your Owner’s Manual for as long as you own
your MARK V.
• We recommend you clean and wax your MARK V
after every five hours of running time.
TECHNICAL ASSISTANCE
If you cannot find the service part you need,
please call our Technical Hotline 1-800-762-7555.
52
Parts Price List
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
514366
190
191
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
—
516338
514595
514247
514305
514411
186923
514312
514114
514373
514367
514358
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
514361
514363
521979
504267
514364
514365
514113
514473
514480
514410
514407
521981
514486
147114
502973
Upper Saw Guard Assembly
(incl. 190-199)
Upper Guard and Insert
Label
Upper Guard Insert
Hinge Pin
Retaining Ring
Cap Screw
Support Link
Support Link Spacer
Support Link Hub
Riving Knife Assembly
Lower Saw Guard Assembly
(incl. 202-216)
Inner Guard Assembly
Guide Rod Spring
Guard Cover
Washer
Cover Lock Knob
Carriage Bolt
Lock Plate
O Ring
Guard Lock Knob
Stop Screw
Retaining Ring
Guard and Pin Assembly
Guard Stud
Socket Head Screw
Lock Washer
Qty.
Price
Each
$81.99
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
23.19
1.59
2.43
0.84
0.80
0.80
15.83
1.25
1.44
44.42
83.88
1
2
1
3
2
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
19.87
0.80
14.11
0.80
1.46
0.80
4.44
0.80
2.31
0.80
0.80
47.91
0.80
0.80
0.80
www.shopsmith.com
MARK V
Main Work Table
Main Work Table
(Model 505/510)
(Model 520)
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
137
138
139
140
141
142
144
145
146
147
148
—
515698
501637
51410004
51409702
514351
514667
515294
120392
514440
514101
501633
514620
514339
149
150
151
152
153
154
154A
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
—
514130
514340
514341
514466
514342
517829
514040
514115
514634
514353
518372
514350
514104
120393
514311
514344
514448
164
165
166
514447
5042559
502680
Table Assembly (Incl. 137-166)
Hex Socket Head Screw
Table Insert (Center Saw)
Table
Taptite Screw
Table Tube
Keps Nut
Flat Washer
Jackscrew
Table Tube Spacer
Washer
Rear Trunnion
Front Trunnion Assembly
(incl. 149-153)
Front Trunnion
Table Stop Pin
Compression Spring
Washer
Retaining Ring
Button Head Socket Screw
10-24 x 5/16˝ Phil Pan Screw
Tie Bar Guard
Rod and Shoe Assembly
Shoe Spring
Table Stop Bolt
Table Stop Bolt
Front Clamp Shoe
Washer
Indicator Plate
Table Bar and Tube
Table Lock Handle Assembly
(incl. 164-166)
Table Lock Nut
Table Tilt Lock
Retaining Ring
1-800-543-7586
Qty.
2
1
1
4
2
6
6
4
6
4
1
Price
Each
Ref.
No.
$638.33
0.80
27.80
190.52
0.85
24.80
0.80
0.80
4.92
0.80
0.80
36.69
47.15
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
2
2
3
1
1
1
1
40.50
2.51
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
5.05
24.36
0.80
0.80
0.80
6.39
0.80
6.48
153.21
12.80
1
1
1
3.79
8.24
0.80
Qty.
Price
Each
Part No.
Description
—
136
136A
137
138
139
139A
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
—
522363
515859
518462
501637
51410004
51409702
522271
514351
522298
515294
518490
120392
518460
518403
501633
514620
514339
149
150
151
152
153
154
154A
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
514130
514340
514341
514466
514342
517829
514040
514115
514634
514353
518372
514350
514104
120393
514311
514344
Table Assembly (incl. 136-166)
$674.99
Knob
4
1.09
Spring
4
0.85
Hex Socket Head Screw
2
0.80
Table Insert (Center Saw)
1
27.80
Table
1
190.52
Rubber Magnet, 8-3/4˝ (not shown) 1
1.96
Taptite Screw
4
0.80
Front Rail Assembly
1
79.54
Keps Nut
6
0.80
Rear Rail Assembly
1
52.11
Flat Washer
6
0.80
Flat Head Screw
6
0.80
Table Spacer
6
0.80
Washer
4
0.80
Rear Trunnion
1
36.69
Front Trunnion Assembly
47.15
(incl. 149-153)
Front Trunnion
1
40.50
Table Stop Pin
1
2.61
Compression Spring
1
0.80
Washer
1
0.80
Retaining Ring
1
0.80
Button Head Socket Screw
2
0.80
10-24 x 5/16˝ Phil Pan Screw
2
0.80
Tie Bar Guard
1
5.05
Rod and Shoe Assembly
1
24.36
Shoe Spring
2
0.80
Table Stop Bolt
2
0.80
Table Stop Bolt
3
0.80
Front Clamp Shoe
1
6.39
Washer
1
0.80
Indicator Plate
1
6.48
Table Bar and Tube
1
153.21
(Continued on next page)
Parts Price List
53
MARK V
Main Work Table, continued
Rip Fence
(Model 520)
(Model 505/510)
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
514448
164
165
166
514447
5042559
502680
Table Lock Handle Assembly
(incl. 164-166)
Table Lock Nut
Table Tilt Lock
Retaining Ring
Qty.
Price
Each
$12.80
1
1
1
3.79
8.24
0.80
Floating & Extension Table
(Model 505/510)
Note: The floating extension table,
connector tubes and telescoping legs
have their own parts list. Please refer to
that literature for safety, assembly and
operation information.
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
516578
—
516015
—
514446
—
516014
242
243
244
245
246
247
248
249
250
504273
514107
†
514101
514440
514663
515294
120392
120394
Extension Table & Base Assembly
(incl. 242-251)
Extension Table Assembly
(incl. 243-251)
Floating Table
(incl. 243, 245-251)
Extension Table w/Studs
(incl. 243-244)
Extension Table Base
Extension Table
Table Stud Assembly
Tube Spacer
Jack Screw
Tube & Welded Studs
Keps Nut
Flat Washer
Washer
Qty.
2
Price
Each
$187.98
126.92
1
113.44
87.66
1
1
4
4
2
2
4
4
8
51.37
74.02
0.80
4.92
14.29
0.80
0.80
0.80
TECHNICAL ASSISTANCE
If you cannot find the service part you need,
please call our Technical Hotline 1-800-762-7555.
54
Parts Price List
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
514378
217
218
—
515286
515114
514455
219
220
221
—
514259
514454
514391
514930
222
223
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
—
515328
514924
514925
515426
502333
514568
514463
514389
514407
514353
514465
232
233
234
—
517838
514527
514257
514379
235
236
237
238
239
240
241
241A
514254
102388
514531
514567
514386
514527
514384
514568
Rip Fence Assembly
(incl. 217-241) (incl. 190-199)
Lock Nut
Fence Cap
Outfeed Clamp Assembly
(incl. 219-220)
Clamp
Protector
Rollpin
Fence Extrusion Assembly
(incl. 222-224)
Fence Extrusion
Fence Post
Screw
Pan Head Sems Screw
Flat Washer
Screw
Spring
Rollpin
Retaining Ring
Spring
Handle & Rod Assembly
(incl. 232-234)
Fence Lock Rod
Rollpin
Handle
Base Assembly
(incl. 235-240)
Fence Base
Setscrew
Dowel Pin
Infeed Clamp
Retaining Ring
Rollpin
Knob
Screw
Qty.
Price
Each
$161.51
1
1
0.80
2.42
11.63
1
1
1
10.04
0.80
0.80
70.44
1
1
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
63.80
3.94
0.80
0.80
0.80
10.34
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
26.03
1
1
1
13.40
0.80
11.49
51.55
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
19.23
0.80
1.14
8.18
0.80
0.80
6.84
10.34
www.shopsmith.com
MARK V
Pro Fence Assembly
Floating Tables (2) & Extension Table (1)
(Model 520)
(Model 520)
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
522359
217
217A
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
232
518419
522287
518400
517829
518404
514317
518420
518405
518407
521578
518410
518409
518423
518461
518459
518416
514527
Pro Fence Assembly
(incl. 217-232)
Fence Base
1
Indicator Block Assembly (Not Shown)
Fence Extrusion
1
Screw 1/4˝-20 x 1/2˝ Button Hd
4
Front Pad (not shown)
4
Plate-Wear
2
Spring Block
1
Locking Bar Rod
2
Locking Bar
2
Locking Handle
2
Rod-Long
1
Rod-Short
1
Rear Pad
1
Screw #10-24 Flat Hd
2
Lock Nut
2
Spring
2
Rollpin
2
Qty.
Price
Each
$302.49
48.39
6.74
96.75
0.80
1.27
1.04
8.44
1.22
5.64
7.76
8.26
2.30
1.27
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
Tips & Techniques
Ref.
No.
Part No.
—
522375
Description
Extension Table & Base Assembly
(incl. 239-251)
—
522369
Extension Table Assembly
(incl. 240-249)
—
522368
Floating Table
(incl. 240,242-249)
—
516014
Extension Table with Studs
(incl. 240-241)
239
504273
Extension Table Base
240
514107
Extension Table
241
†
Table Stud Assembly
242
518403
Table Spacer
243
518460
Flat Head Screw
244
522297
Front Rail Assm. Ext Table
245
518491
Rear Rail Assm. Ext Table
246
515859
Knob
247
518462
Spring
248
515294
Lock Nut
249
120392
Flat Washer
250
120394
Washer
251
120377
Hex Nut
† Not available as a service part.
Qty.
Price
Each
$231.26
184.49
172.11
86.64
1
3
4
12
12
3
3
6
6
12
12
8
8
52.37
74.31
0.80
0.80
43.34
30.17
1.09
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
• Sharpen your saw blades, lathe chisels and drill bits.
A sharp cutter performs better and is safer.
• Be sure you lubricate the sheaves after every 25
hours of running time. Do not use penetrating oil
or oil in aerosol cans, as they tend to gum up at low
temperatures.
• 50-hour maintenance should be performed on
your MARK V at least once a year – refer to your
Owner’s Manual.
TECHNICAL ASSISTANCE
If you cannot find the service part you need,
please call our Technical Hotline 1-800-762-7555.
1-800-543-7586
Tips & Techniques
• To assure your extension table mounts easily, clean,
wax and buff the tubes. Paste, floor or furniture wax
protects and lubricates.
• File or sharpen dull blades, replace worn-out blades
and resurface scored blade guide blocks.
• If your miter gauge binds in slots, it could be a bent
bar, the table may need replaced, burrs in
the table slot, or bar or table slots need clean
and waxed.
Parts Price List
55
MARK V
BANDSAW
Bandsaw
Miter Gauge & Miter Gauge Safety Grip
(Model 505/510/520)
This Bandsaw Parts List and Exploded Views supplements Bandsaw instruction
manual (845539). Also included optional accessories: Bandsaw Fence and Bandsaw
Table Extension.
Part Numbers 1-53, 111, 112
Ref.
No.
Part No.
—
505625
Description
Safety Grip Assembly
(incl. 252-267)
252
450213
Tapping Screw
253
450219
Tapping Screw
254
450217
Tapping Screw
255
†
Right Grip
256
†
Left Grip
257
†
Trigger
259
501467
Lever Spring
260
501464
Lever Lock
261
132066
Machine Screw
262
501466
Grip Stud
—
555125
Quick Clamp Assembly
(incl. 263-267)
263
222458
Setscrew
264
†
Lock Guide
265
†
Lock Clamp
266
514310
Grip Knob
267
514464
Rod and Shoe Assembly
—
505700
Miter Gauge Assembly
(incl. 268-284)
268
504268
Lock Knob
269
120392
Washer
270
514566
Glide
271
507367
Protractor
272
501407
Headless Stop Screw
273
436691
Pan Head Machine Screw
274
501616
Washer
275
501409
Vernier Plate
276
514424
Indicator Mount & Plunger Assembly
276A
†
Miter Stop Plunger
277
504267
Special Washer
278
504266
Miter Stud
279
501401
Taper Screw
280
518104
Miter Gauge Bar
281
501635
Machine Screw
282
501639
Nylock Machine Screw
283
514376
Washer
284
514377
Screw
† Not available as a service part.
56
Parts Price List
Qty.
Price
Each
$47.23
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
3
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
1.45
0.80
4.06
25.19
0.80
2.42
8.55
70.75
4.61
0.80
13.42
29.06
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
15.57
0.80
0.92
3.53
29.46
0.80
0.80
2.27
0.80
Ref.
No.
Part No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
7A
7B
502542
514525
†
522088
102582
522221
522217
516027
522087
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
501626
502700
436732
501470
502690
502686
5027029
502701
122040
120393
120373
517640
114663
502685
502704
502703
Description
Qty.
FRAME AND COVER
Main Frame Assembly
Label
Date Code Label
Hex Stud
Allen Setscrew, 5/16˝-18
Cover and Decal
Plastic Shield
Screw, Button Head
Washer
BLADE TENSIONING ASSEMBLY
Retaining Ring
Thrust Washer
Panhead Screw, 10-24 x 1/2˝
Washer, 7/32˝
Tension Indicator Scale
Retaining Ring
Blade Tension Nut
Tension Spring
Hex Bolt, 5/16˝-18 x 1-1/2˝
Washer, 5/16˝
Square Nut, 5/16˝
Upper Wheel Arm and Axle
Flathead Screw, 5/16˝-18 x 3/4˝
Bracket
Fiber Washer
Left-hand Special Screw
Price
Each
1
1
1
3
2
1
1
3
3
$207.69
1.43
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
3.36
0.80
7.52
6.23
0.80
0.80
0.80
15.22
0.80
6.74
0.80
8.15
3.03
0.80
61.27
5.05
0.80
0.80
(Continued on next page)
www.shopsmith.com
BANDSAW
Ref.
No.
Part No.
—
502691
26
517642
—
509032
30
30A
31
120834
120214
502726
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
517635
501470
120393
426367
502667
502675
515013
502676
517021
120394
517084
502699
513061
274737
516438
517085
514053
50
51
52
53
51368601
5137779
5035769
222458
Description
UPPER WHEEL
Upper Wheel Assembly
(incl. 24, 25)
Retaining Ring
LOWER WHEEL
Lower Wheel Assembly
(incl. 28, 29)
Hex Bolt, 5/16˝-18 x 1/2˝
Washer
Bearing Retainer
TABLE TRUNNIONS
Pan Head Screw, 10-24
Washer, 7/32˝
Washer, 5/16˝
Hex Bolt, 5/16˝-18 x 1/2˝
Tilt Indicator Scale
Trunnion
Trunnion Support
Washer, 19/32˝
Bushing
Washer, 3/8˝
Stop Nut, 3/8˝-24
Thrust Washer
Tilt Lock Assembly
Hex Nut, 10-24
Table Clamp Bolt, 3/8˝-24 x 3˝
Screw
Thin Shim Washer
MISCELLANEOUS
Allen Wrench, 5/32˝
Eccentric Mounting Tube
Drive Hub
Setscrew
Part Numbers 54-110
1-800-543-7586
Qty.
Price
Each
$79.56
1
0.80
107.20
1
1
1
0.80
0.80
1.46
2
2
4
4
1
2
2
3
2
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
4
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.84
8.08
3.33
0.80
4.16
0.80
1.87
0.80
16.25
0.80
0.93
2.08
0.80
1
2
1
1
1.74
17.72
2.58
0.80
Ref.
No.
Part No.
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
514008
120380
514011
502682
120375
426367
120214
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
83A
84
85
86
514008
120380
514007
122017
517908
120214
120393
502552
124824
5025499
5025549
502550
515412
502657
5025779
222458
502656
502575
501637
5025589
502574
502659
522223
522216
120706
124818
502555
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
516113
503782
126315
515954
516571
124824
516165
516043
516173
516029
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
—
111
112
120380
514007
5025779
222458
502656
502575
502574
502659
514008
502666
102634
5025809
120214
122017
522251
448027
522219
Description
Qty.
AUTO-TRACK BLADE GUIDE
Shoulder Screw
Lock Washer
Auto-Track Roller Bearing
Mounting Bracket
Hex Nut, 1/4˝-20
Hex Bolt, 5/16˝-18 x 3/4˝
Lock Washer, 5/16˝
UPPER BLADE GUIDE AND GUARD
Shoulder Screw
Lock Washer
Roller Bearing
Hex Bolt, 5/16˝-18 x 3/4˝
Nylon Bolt
Lock Washer, 5/16˝
Washer, 3/16˝
Headless Slot Setscrew, 5/16˝
Jam Nut, 5/16˝
Guide Column Bracket
Blade Guide Column Post
Guide Lock Spring
Special Screw, 5/16˝-18 x 1-3/8˝
Upper Long Guide Block
Guide Block Bracket
Allen Setscrew, 5/16˝-18 x 1/4˝
Short Guide Block
Guide Block Spring
Flathead Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 1/2˝
Upper Guide Bracket
Guide Adjusting Knob
Fillister Head Screw, 10-24 x 1-1/4˝
Blade Guard (incl. 83a)
Blade Guard Label
Hex Bolt, 1/4˝-20 x 1/2˝
Jam Nut, 1/4˝-20
Height Lock Handle Assembly
TABLE
Bandsaw Table
Knurled Nut
Carriage Bolt
Flat Head Leveling Screws
Socket Head Screw, 5/16˝-18 x 1˝
Hex Nut
T-Slot Extrusion
Flat Head Leveling Screw
Table Insert Assembly
#0 Phillips Head Screwdriver
LOWER BLADE GUIDE
Lock Washer
Roller Bearing
Guide Block Bracket
Allen Setscrew, 5/16˝-18 x 1/4˝
Short Guide Block
Guide Block Spring
Guide Adjusting Knob
Fillister Head Screw, 10-24 x 1-1/4˝
Shoulder Screw
Lower Long Guide Block
Hex Nut, 5/16˝-18
Lower Guide Bracket
Lock Washer, 5/16˝
Hex Bolt, 5/16˝-18 x 1˝
Power Coupler Cover (incl. 111-112)
Screw
Power Shaft Cover
Price
Each
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
$2.49
0.80
5.93
2.08
0.80
0.80
0.80
1
1
1
2
1
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2.49
0.80
12.18
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
12.03
11.77
4.22
3.05
5.10
6.53
0.80
3.00
0.80
0.80
8.53
2.39
1.48
14.75
1.93
0.80
0.80
9.88
1
1
1
4
1
1
1
5
1
1
106.48
4.04
0.80
0.80
2.33
0.80
16.21
0.80
12.52
2.66
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
0.80
12.18
6.53
0.80
3.00
0.80
2.39
1.10
2.49
5.40
0.80
8.45
0.80
0.80
6.50
0.80
6.48
Parts Price List
57
BANDSAW
SCROLL SAW
Table Extension Parts List (555488)
MARK V Mount
(Optional)
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
1
2
3
4
5
555488
501378
120706
120392
516153
515859
Bandsaw Table Extension
Extension Bar
Hex Head Bolt, 7/16˝
Flat Washer
Rod
Knob
Price
Each
Qty.
1
2
2
2
2
$25.77
12.47
0.80
0.80
7.64
1.09
Bandsaw Fence Parts List (555645)
(Optional)
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
555645
Bandsaw Fence
1
518012
Rip Fence Extrusion
2
518005
Roll Pin
3
514392
Special Hex Nut, 5/16˝-18
4
518013
Rear Clamp
5
514463
Spring
6
102634
Hex Nut, 5/16˝-18
7
†
Lock Rod
8
514407
Retaining Ring
9
514353
Spring
10
514257
Rear Clamp Lever
11
514527
Roll Pin
12
102388
Setscrew
13
518016
Handle
14
513792
Flat Washer
15
518018
Fence Base
16
518017
Socket Head Screw, 10-24 x 1˝
17
514317
Wear Plate
18
514463
Spring
19
518011
Front Fence Lock
20
518019
Hex Nut
21
516687
Bar
22
120393
Flat Washer
23
120834
Hex Head Bolt
† Not available as a service part.
58
Parts Price List
Qty.
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
2
1
4
1
1
1
1
1
3
3
Price
Each
$95.86
41.96
0.80
2.03
6.65
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
11.79
0.80
0.80
8.63
0.80
15.36
1.64
1.04
0.80
2.85
2.39
17.28
0.80
0.80
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
Qty.
Price
Each
1
1A
1B
2
3
4
5
6
7
518271
518248
518249
518163
515165
515120
506721
515166
186923
1
1
1
1
1
14
1
1
6
$58.26
7.90
7.90
3.16
3.84
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
16A
17
18
—
20
21
22
23
24
120380
514965
518177
518159
518047
518155
518127
518178
455862
455734
518154
518345
518156
518223
518160
514974
514980
514040
9
1
5
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
2
0.80
4.55
0.80
4.29
2.49
0.80
3.27
2.26
0.80
0.80
1.71
4.44
4.23
2.91
3.00
12.94
0.93
0.80
25
26
518266
518179
Upper Arm Cover
Label – RH
Label – LH
Hood
Bracket
Screw, #10-24 x 3/8˝
Metal Dowel Pin
Spring
Socket Head Cap Screw,
1/4˝-20 x 5/8˝
Lock Washer, 1/4˝
Tubing Cover
Flat Washer
Barrel Nut
Lock Knob
Setscrew
Lever
Quick Release Lever
Rollpin, 1/8˝ x 7/8˝
Rollpin, 1/8˝ x 3/4˝
Upper Blade Block
Thumbscrew
Special Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 3/4˝
Lower Blade Block
Spacer
Upper Rocker
Spring
Button Head Screw,
#10-24 x 5/16˝
Upper Arm w/Shaft
Rollpin
1
1
35.89
0.80
(Continued on next page)
www.shopsmith.com
SCROLL SAW
Ref.
No.
Part No.
27
28
514975
514236
Description
Lower Rocker
Button Head Cap Screw,
1/4˝-20 x 5/8˝
36
518265
Lower Arm w/Shaft
38
513732
Rollpin, 3/16˝ x 7/8˝
39
518111
Tensioning Rod
41
514411
Retaining Ring
42
514979
Spring
43
514978
Lock Pin
44
514353
Spring
45
514407
Retaining Ring
46
515072
Pump Rod
47
515178
Tube Seal
48
515119
Special Washer
49
502239
Pump Seal
50
514053
Flat Washer
51
515299
Lock Nut
52
515073
Pump Housing
53
515105
Tubing
54
514967
Link Assembly
55
514973
Link Bolt
56
518165
Puffer Tube
57
518243
Nylon Clamp
58
518125
Hold Down / Guard
59
513897
Nut, #10-32
60
517978
Screw, #10-32 x 3/8˝
61
517982
Screw, #10-24 x 1/2˝
62
518094
Post
63
120391
Washer
65
518338
Table
66
518153
Screw, #10-32 x 1˝
67
518152
Spacer
71
518274
Table Trunnion
72
515127
Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 3/4˝
73
518431
Table Lock Knob
74
518009
Flat Washer
75
518273
Base Trunnion
76
502885
Table Tilt Indicator
77
513623
Screw, #6-32 x 5/16˝
78
†
Frame Assembly, RH
79
†
Frame Assembly, LH
80
518175
Washer
80A
518176
Washer
81
516232
Logo Label
82
518141
Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 2-1/2˝
85
513885
Jam Nut, 1/4˝-20
87
518102
Rear Cradle
90
518188
Base
91
514992
Base Plate
93
513201
Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 3/4˝
95
120392
Flat Washer
96
515071
(MKV) Drive Pinion
97
518360
Weight and Shaft
98A
518172
Gear
98B
515089
Gear
99
517982
Screw
100
502973
Split Lock Washer
101
515118
Gear Cover
† Not available as a service part.
Qty.
Price
Each
1
1
$2.96
0.80
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
7
1
4
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
4
3
3
1
1
1
2
10
1
2
1
1
7
6
1
41.99
0.80
11.87
0.80
0.80
3.74
0.80
0.80
8.96
1.10
4.64
16.03
0.80
0.80
4.28
4.18
24.87
3.74
8.75
0.80
8.69
0.80
0.80
0.80
7.64
0.80
176.50
0.80
0.80
24.29
0.80
13.68
0.80
22.61
1.83
0.80
0.80
1.50
1.49
0.80
0.80
3.92
263.85
13.76
0.80
0.80
23.81
35.82
3.00
3.03
0.80
0.80
6.91
TECHNICAL ASSISTANCE
If you cannot find the service part you need,
please call our Technical Hotline 1-800-762-7555.
1-800-543-7586
Stand Mount
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
Qty.
103
104
104
105
105
106
106
107
107
108
109
110
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
122
123
125
130
131
132
133
138
139
140
141
142
143
222460
515133
515133
515135
515135
518169
518169
518170
518170
518168
514642
515140
515204
5137779
515587
222458
503572
515098
†
518228
515264
518166
518240
518114
120372
115546
514736
514191
513411
513760
513897
502973
(MKV) Base Setscrew
(MKV) Ball Bearing
(MTZD) Ball Bearing
(MTZD) Ball Bearing Spacer
(MKV) Ball Bearing Spacer
(MTZD)Retaining Ring
(MKV) Retaining Ring
(MTZD) Retaining Ring
(MKV) Retaining Ring
(MTZD) Driven Pulley
(MTZD) Knob
Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 1-3/4˝
(MTZD) Pulley Spacer
(MKV) Eccentric Tube
(MTZD) Setscrew
(MKV) Setscrew
(MKV) Accessory Hub
(MTZD) Motor
Motor Clamp
(MTZD) Drive Pulley
(MTZD) Plug
(MTZD) O-Ring Belt
(MTZD) Leg
(MTZD) Screw,1/4˝-20 x 5/8˝
(MTZD) Square Nut, 1/4˝-20
(MTZD) Internal Tooth Washer
(MTZD) Speed Control Box
(MTZD) Speed Control Decal
(MTZD) Safety Key
(MTZD) Screw, #10-32 x 1-3/4˝
(MTZD) Nut, #10-32
(MTZD) Split Lock Washer
2
6
4
1
3
2
3
2
3
1
1
4
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
4
12
12
12
1
1
1
3
3
3
Price
Each
$0.80
11.76
11.76
1.11
1.11
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
56.72
1.63
0.80
3.12
17.72
1.24
0.80
3.05
407.81
26.80
0.80
2.44
38.06
0.80
0.80
0.80
324.53
2.28
4.52
0.80
0.80
0.80
† Not available as a service part.
Important Note
(MK V) – Mark V Mount Scroll Saw ONLY
(MTZD) – Stand Mount Motorized Scroll Saw ONLY
Parts Price List
59
STRIP SANDER
Strip Sander
Ref.
No.
1
2
3
3A
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
29A
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
60
Part No.
Description
Qty.
Part No.
Description
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
222460
515380
126315
503782
514746
102634
517829
47
48
49
50
52
53
515418
514490
513739
515394
5137769
515568
Setscrew, 5/16˝-18 x 3/8˝
Table
Carriage Bolt, 1/4˝-20 x 1˝
Knurled Nut
Setscrew, 5/16˝-18 x 1˝
Hex Nut, 5/16˝-18
Button Head Screw,
1/4˝-20 x 1/2˝
Trunnion
Flat Washer, 1-1/8˝
Flat Washer, 3/4˝
Table Lock Knob
Eccentric Mounting Tubes
S Clip
Qty.
Price
Each
2
1
1
1
1
1
2
$0.80
33.21
0.80
4.04
0.92
0.80
0.80
1
1
1
1
2
1
11.76
0.80
0.80
23.77
10.88
1.52
BELT SANDER
Price
Each
518377
Cover (Incl. 3)
1
$23.73
516232
Logo
2
1.49
516825
Warning Label
1
2.21
516826
Label
1
6.30
516421
Tracking Wheel & Shaft Assembly
1
36.55
515403
Wheel Plate
1
10.67
126335
Carriage Bolt, 1/4˝-20 x 1-1/2˝
1
0.80
514040
Pan Head Screw, 10-24 x 5/16˝
4
0.80
515399
Hinge
2
8.39
274737
Hex Nut, 10-24
4
0.80
515382
Frame
1
74.53
515610
Pan Head Screw, 10-32 x 3/8˝
4
0.80
Note: Items 11 and 13 are used to bolt item 1 to item 10.
515805
Socket Head Cap Screw,
1/4˝-20 x 1
2
2.58
514204
Hex Nut, 1/4˝-20
1
0.80
518122
Nylon Washers
2
0.80
516399
Idler Wheel
2
13.90
515423
Idler Wheel Guard
1
3.00
515417
Spring
1
0.95
515401
External Retaining Ring
1
0.80
513971
Socket Head Cap Screw,
1
0.80
1/4˝-20 x 1/2˝
504267
Flat Washer, 5/8˝
1
0.80
515402
Wheel Bracket
1
5.64
515427
Tracking Control Knob
1
12.24
515392
Drive Wheel and Bearing Assembly 1
53.49
513809
Socket Head Cap Screw,
1
0.80
5/16˝-18 x 5/8˝
502726
Clamp
1
1.46
515309
Nameplate Label
1
0.80
515408
Trunnion Guide
1
5.15
514985
Spacer
2
3.87
513201
Button Head Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 3/4˝
2
0.80
222458
Setscrew, 5/16˝-18 x 3/4˝
1
0.80
5035769
Drive Hub
1
2.58
513623
Pan Head Screw, 6-32 x 5/16˝
1
0.80
502885
Indicator
1
1.83
517829
Button Head Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 1/2˝
3
0.80
515395
Platen, 1˝
1
11.14
515397
Platen, 1/2˝
1
11.14
515396
Curved Platen, 1/2˝
1
24.97
514642
Cover Lock Knob
1
1.63
Parts Price List
Ref.
No.
Belt Sander
Parts List and Exploded View updates the 6˝ Belt Sander
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
—
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
502955
†
†
502958
502957
432324
502960
502959
120382
120377
222460
MAIN ASSEMBLY
Tracking Screw Assembly (incl. 1, 2)
Tracking Screw
2
Rollpin, 5/32˝ x 11/16˝
2
Stop Nut
1
Tracking Knob
1
Button Plug
4
Tie Bolt
2
Spacer Tube
2
Spring Lock, Washer, 3/8˝
2
Hex Nut, 3/8˝-16
2
Setscrew, 5/16˝-18 x 3/8˝
4
Qty.
Price
Each
$8.33
6.23
19.88
1.89
1.54
17.85
0.80
0.80
0.80
(Continued on next page)
www.shopsmith.com
BELT SANDER
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
11
12
—
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
19A
19B
20
21
22
—
23
24
25
—
26
27
28
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
503024
5030049
513061
†
†
†
502999
502998
448309
51485402
514521
124818
502698
502988
120388
503402
†
†
†
515565
†
†
†
5029639
514050
51553801
445446
502985
502974
502989
—
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
43A
44
45
46
47
502934
513732
502945
†
†
†
†
504553
515619
502937
†
†
†
—
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
502874
†
†
†
†
†
†
†
501027
502923
—
57
58
59
60
61
502789
†
†
†
†
†
Tinnerman Clip
4
Shaft Cap
1
Table Tilt Assembly (incl. 13-15)
Table Tilt Lock
1
Retaining Ring
1
Locknut
1
Indicator
1
Indicator Washer
1
Self-Tapping Screw, #8-32 x 1/4˝
1
Dust Chute
1
Elbow, 2-1/2˝ Diameter
1
Hex Jam Nut, 1/4˝-20
2
Trunnion Nut, 3/8˝-24
1
Cup
1
Flat Washer, 3/8˝
1
Base Assembly (incl. 23-25)
Base Casting
1
Drive Stud
2
Trunnion Guide
1
Inner Frame Assembly (incl. 26-28)
Rollpin, 1/4˝ x 5/8˝
2
Trunnion
1
Right Frame Side
1
Backup Plate
1
Slotted Flathead Screw
6
Left Outer Frame
1
Tinnerman Clip
6
Trunnion Washer
1
Trunnion Stud
1
Trunnion Lock
1
IDLER DRUM
Idler Drum Assembly (incl. 37-47)
Split Pin, 3/16˝ x 7/8˝
1
Guide Bushing
2
Tension Cam
2
Bearing
2
Idler Drum
1
Spring Plug
2
Washer, 5/8˝
2
Curved Washer
1
Thrust Washer
2
Idler Shaft
1
Torsion Spring
1
Rollpin
1
TENSION KNOB
Tension Knob Assembly (incl. 48-54)
Retaining Ring
1
Lock Washer
1
Latch Spring
1
Tension Knob
1
Drive Screw
1
Washer, 1/8˝
1
Knob Latch
1
Retaining Ring
1
Medallion
1
DRIVE DRUM
Drive Drum Assembly (incl. 57-62)
Ball Bearing
2
Bushing
2
Drive Drum
1
Rollpin
1
Drive Shaft
1
1-800-543-7586
Qty.
Price
Each
Ref.
No.
Part No.
$0.80
4.34
16.25
62
63
64
†
502961
513191
5.82
3.43
0.80
8.87
7.39
0.80
0.80
1.96
0.80
51.78
73.51
28.27
0.80
53.38
1.46
0.88
11.57
14.57
105.69
0.80
7.14
0.93
1.95
0.80
15.62
0.80
0.80
107.01
Description
Qty.
Drive Sleeve
Finger Washer
Socket Head Cap Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 1˝
TABLE
—
503406
Table Assembly (incl. 65-71)
65
†
Rollpin, 1/4˝ x 7/8˝
66
120388
Flat Washer, 3/8˝
67
518307
Table Lock Bolt
67A
502318
Special Washer
68
†
Table
69
502992
Support Spacer
70
†
Tilt Slide
71
†
Drive Stud
—
503407
Support Assembly (incl. 72, 73)
72
†
Mounting Rod
73
†
Table Support
MISCELLANEOUS
74
5137779
Eccentric Mounting Tube
75
115321
Setscrew, 5/16˝-18 x 5/16˝
76
120377
Hex Nut, 3/8˝-16
77
120394
Washer, 3/8˝
78
122181
Hex Head Cap Screw, 3/8˝-16 x 2˝
79
5035769
Drive Hub
80
222458
Setscrew
—
51368601
Allen Wrench, 5/32˝
† Not available as a service part.
1
2
2
Price
Each
$1.52
0.80
158.65
2
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
0.80
2.82
2.98
7.28
49.84
2
1
2
2
1
2
1
1
1
1
17.72
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
2.58
0.80
1.74
Tips & Techniques
• For the safety and well-being of the built-in motor,
it is always preferable to have the MARK V
connected to an independent line without an
extension cord. If it is necessary in your situation
to use an extension cord, it must be of heavy
enough gauge cord to provide the proper current.
For extension cords up to 20 feet, use no less
than a 14-gauge, three-conductor cord. For
20-100 feet, use no less than a 10-gauge,
three-conductor extension cord.
• Please remember that the cord and plug should be
replaced immediately if they become damaged.
No matter how long you’ve owned your MARK V,
it needs a little tender care after every 10 hours of
operation. This will guarantee trouble-free woodworking year after year:
• Run your MARK V up to high speed, turn off and
unplug it. Remove the screws holding the belt
cover and slide it away from the headstock. Also,
remove the nameplate with a screwdriver (this
plate can’t be removed on 1953 and 1954
models – drop the motor instead).
• Clean the sawdust out of the headstock with an air
compressor, vacuum cleaner or tire pump. Check
the belts for wear, then lubricate the motor shaft
and sheave with two drops of 3-in-1 oil.
Parts Price List
61
JOINTER
Jointer
Ref.
No.
Part No.
—
516181
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
502883
502884
120388
502920
120377
222460
514057
513918
516225
145372
502885
513623
502964
5028869
132277
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
—
120380
120372
514057
514072
†
513913
513944
160515
517363
26
†
27
502898
28 & 29 5029059
62
Description
MAIN JOINTER ASSEMBLY
Base and table assembly
(incl. 1-7)
Depth-Of-Cut Adjustment Shaft
Table Mount Stud
3/8˝ Flat Washer
Spring Washer
3/8˝-16 Hex Nut
5/16˝-18 x 3/8˝ Allen Setscrew
Phillips Pan Head Screw, 10-24
Drive Shaft Guard
Depth-Of-Cut-Scale
Drive Screw, #4 x 1/4˝
Depth-Of-Cut Pointer
Pan Head Screw, #6-32 x 5/16˝
Depth-Of-Cut Adjustment Knob
Fence Mounting Bar
Fillister Head Cap Screw,
1/4˝-20 x 1˝
Lock Washer, 1/4˝
Square Nut, 1/4˝-20
Slotted Screw, #10-32
Support Bracket (Incl. 22 & 23)
Infeed Stop
Shoulder Screw
Chip Chute Assembly
Slotted Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 7/8˝
Cutter Head Assembly
(incl. 26-34)
Cutter Head
Ball Bearing
Bearing Housing (used both sides)
Parts Price List
Qty.
Price
Each
$218.18
1
1
3
2
1
2
2
1
1
3
1
1
1
1
1
1.79
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
12.12
1.13
0.80
1.83
0.80
20.54
15.38
0.80
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
2
0.80
0.80
0.80
19.82
1
2
2
1.55
6.62
0.80
172.60
Ref.
No.
Part No.
30
31
521945
147118
Description
Qty.
Wedge
Hex Socket Cap Screw,
#10-32 x 3/4˝
33
502899
Knife Leveling Screw
34
505640
Knives (set of 3)
35
120392
Flat Washer, 9/32˝
36
502930
Lock Washer, 1/4˝
37
454479
Hex Head Cap Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 1˝
FENCE
—
513947
Fence Assembly (incl. 38-50)
38
522252
Fence
39
514040
Phillips Pan Head Screw,
#10-24 x 5/16˝
40
513948
Guard
41
†
Label
—
502651
Quadrant Assembly (incl. 42-44)
43
502889
Stop-Tab
44
513734
Rollpin, 1/8˝ x 5/8˝
45
501407
Auto-Stop (Nylock setscrew)
46
506721
Dowel Pin, 1/4˝ x 7/8˝
47
516077
Flat Washer, 1/2˝
48
502895
Guide Bushing
49
502890
Handle & Hub Assembly
50
506720
Sleeve Screw
555480
Featherguard Retro
—
†
Featherguard Assembly
51A
†
Guard
51B
†
Warning Label
51C
516232
Logo
52
51398901
Adjuster Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 1/4˝
53
516401
Knob
54
515847
Thrust Washer
55
514196
Spring
56
502909
Torque Washer
57
514273
Washer, 1/2˝
58
514049
Retaining Ring
59
514272
Threaded Stud
60A
120393
Washer, 11/32˝
60B
513857
Hex Nut, 5/16˝-18
60C
518492
Stop Pin
60D
516222
Stop Knob
60E
†
Stop Stud Assembly, 1/4˝-28 Black
MISCELLANEOUS
61
5020809
Eccentric Mounting Tube
62
503572
Drive Hub
63
222458
Setscrew
—
51368603
5/32˝ Allen Wrench
—
518220
Push Block
† Not available as a service part.
Price
Each
3
9
$15.03
0.80
6
1
2
2
2
0.80
40.60
0.80
0.80
0.80
1
2
152.14
70.86
0.80
1
1
1
1
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
3
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
18.83
43.32
1.60
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
4.66
15.28
1.49
46.77
1.49
0.80
2.43
0.80
3.36
1.60
0.80
0.80
3.98
0.80
0.80
14.13
1.22
3.96
3.05
0.80
0.80
16.76
Shopsmith is dedicated to being your
Lifetime Woodworking Partner
Subscribe today to our
“Woodshop Tips”
It’s delivered to your email address. Don’t miss out on
these exciting tips and techniques. Sign up today.
www.shopsmith.com
9.48
54.11
It’s Free!
www.shopsmith.com
DUST COLLECTOR
Ref.
No.
Dust Collector
19
19A
19B
19C
20
21
22
23
24
25
—
25A
25B
26
27
28
29
30
31
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
1
—
514808
514809
2
3
4
—
514856
514966
514855
515595
5
6
7
—
515689
515561
515534
515596
8
9
10
11
12
—
13
14
15
16
17
18
515549
515562
515533
515112
120392
515287
†
515551
513627
120388
515535
515248
Filter Hood
Retaining Strap Assembly
(Incl. 2-4)
Strap, Metal
Rack
Clamp
Main Housing Assembly
(Incl. 5-29)
Main Housing w/Warning Label
Self-Tapping Screw
Support Bracket
Motor and Blower Assembly
(Incl. 8-20)
Inlet Seal
Self-Tapping Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 3/4˝
Fan Housing
Hex Head Cap Screw, 1/4˝-20 x 1˝
Flat Washer, 3/8˝
Fan Assembly (incl. 11-13)
Fan
Spacer
Hex Head Cap Screws, 3/8˝-6 x 1
Flat Washer
Motor Housing
Key, Square, 3/16˝
1-800-543-7586
Qty.
Price
Each
1
1
$35.20
16.34
1
1
1
1
7.86
2.46
5.10
614.31
1
4
1
1
92.54
0.80
7.27
441.60
1
6
1
1
4
1
1
1
4
4
1
1
1.04
0.80
43.13
0.80
0.80
34.00
1.62
0.80
0.80
48.22
0.80
Part No.
Description
Qty.
515690
515563
515586
514881
515550
515137
514832
514817
515562
51476702
521769
521761
521762
515555
515553
515219
518393
300006
514831
Motor w/Plug
1
Connector
1
Strain Relief
1
Screw
2
Motor Seal
1
Self-Tapping Screw
2
Self-Tapping Screw, #10-16 x 1/2˝ 4
Cover Plate
1
Self-Tapping Screw
4
3-Way Inlet
1
Handle Package (Incl. 25A-25B)
1
Handle
1
Screw
2
Self-Tapping Screw
6
Cable Clip
1
Bag Clip
3
Retaining Strap Assembly
1
Bag, Package of 6
1
Hex Head Cap Screw,
4
1/4˝-20 x 1-3/8˝
32
120380
Spring Lock Washer, 1/4˝
4
33
514896
Rear Handle
1
—
522388
Switch Service Pack (incl. 34-34A) 1
34
†
Switch
1
34A
515107
Switch Key
1
35
515547
Leg Cap, Right
1
36
515552
Wiring Harness
1
36A
522323
Wire Cover
1
36B
515555
Self-Tapping Screw
1
37
515546
Right Leg
1
38
515554
Leg Cap, Left
1
39
515664
Left Leg
1
40
51481208
Snap-In Plug
8
41
515138
Truss Head Screw
14
42
120214
Lock Washer
14
43
102634
Nut, 5/16˝-20
14
44
514807
Wheel Retainer
2
45
514806
Wheel
2
46
514755
Wheel Shaft
1
47
51478902
Base Pan
1
48
514805
Caster
2
—
514890
Attachment Kit (Incl. 49-56)
1
49
514825
Extension Wand
2
—
514929
Inlet Pug Assembly (Incl. 50-51)
2
50
514824
Inlet Plug
2
51
514928
Cap
2
52
514826
Floor Pickup
1
53
514828
Elbow Brush
1
54
300004
Hose
2
55
300007
Reducer (Optional-Only needed when
used with MARK V Model 500)
56
514829
Utility Pickup
1
57
515670
Power Cord
1
58
515126
Star Washer
2
59
513897
Hex Nut, #10-32
2
† Not available as a service part.
Price
Each
$306.32
1.86
5.00
0.80
1.32
0.80
0.80
5.76
0.80
26.49
15.87
15.19
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
7.86
10.97
0.80
0.80
32.06
28.76
2.67
2.64
6.74
3.36
0.80
51.44
1.90
43.49
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
2.16
8.66
7.05
78.15
3.36
77.41
10.96
4.69
3.36
0.80
12.06
17.45
25.61
4.61
7.46
17.20
0.80
0.80
TECHNICAL ASSISTANCE
If you cannot find the service part you need,
please call our Technical Hotline 1-800-762-7555.
Parts Price List
63
MARK V MOUNT PLANER
Ref.
No.
12˝ Thickness Planer
MARK V Mount
29B
29C
30
31
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
Part No.
Description
Qty.
513794
51398901
†
514039
514037
513380
513986
513730
†
†
†
†
Washer
Setscrew
Table Mounting Post
Table
Barrel Nut
Thickness Pointer
Screw, 10-32 x 3/8˝
Tie Bar with Bushings
Shim Washer
Tension Adjustment Sprocket
Roll Pin
Chain
MISCELLANEOUS
42
513414
Knife Setting Gauge
43
51368601
5/32˝ Allen Wrench
44
51368604
3/16˝ Allen Wrench
45
51368607
1/8˝ Allen Wrench
46
51368605
3/32˝ Allen Wrench
† Not available as a service part.
EXPLODED
VIEW - A
4
4
4
1
4
1
1
4
4
4
4
1
Price
Each
$0.80
0.80
315.72
9.16
6.80
0.80
38.01
1
1
1
1
1
5.82
1.75
1.75
1.75
1.75
Qty.
Price
Each
12˝ Thickness Planer
Main Assembly
Ref.
No.
Part No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
513393
513794
513369
513394
513395
513385
2
7
8
9
10
11
12
12A
—
513794
†
†
†
555115
513391
†
514534
516075
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
502899
502051
5035769
†
513406
513363
505982
†
†
2
27
—
28
29
29A
†
51413703
†
514036
51399401
513857
Description
ANTI-KICKBAK ASSEMBLY 2
Long Tube Spacer
Washer
Anti-Kickback Wedge
Short Tube Spacer
Anti-Kickback Rod
Cotter Pin
FEED ROLLER ASSEMBLIES
Washer
Pivot Arm
Special Washer
Pivot Screw
Infeed Roller
Woodruff Key
Spacer Washer
Outfeed Roller
Cutterhead Assembly
(includes 13-21)
Knife Leveling Screw
Setscrew
Drive Hub
Ball Bearing
Wedge Locking Screw
Knife Wedge
Knife (set of 3)
Cutterhead
Chip Deflector
TABLE ASSEMBLY
Washer
Thickness Adjustment
Crank Assembly
Table Connector
Setscrew
Prevailing Torque Nut
Qty.
Price
Each
2
2
11
10
1
1
$1.28
0.80
0.80
0.80
12.33
0.80
4
4
8
4
1
2
4
1
0.80
9
1
1
2
24
6
1
1
1
8
1
1
4
4
4
EXPLODED
VIEW - B
53.15
0.80
52.08
385.56
0.80
0.80
2.58
0.80
3.20
82.90
38.21
37.80
0.80
0.80
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
2
36
47
48
49
49A
50
51
52
53
513794
513986
513348
514207
513191
513386
120380
51336001
†
513782
MAIN PLANER ASSEMBLY
Washer
Screw, 10-32 x 3/8˝
Infeed Shield
Feed Rate Label
Socket Hd. Cap Screw
Screw, 1/4˝-20
Lock Washer
Drive Hub Cover
Left End Frame
Screw, 8-32
4
8
1
1
4
6
6
1
1
1
$0.80
0.80
38.98
12.70
0.80
5.22
0.80
18.39
0.80
(Continued on next page)
64
Parts Price List
www.shopsmith.com
PRO PLANER - STAND MOUNT
Ref.
No.
Part No.
54
55
56
56A
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
449613
51372304
518386
516540
513738
513752
513376
513389
†
513720
513721
513722
†
†
513739
120214
513795
513402
513857
513746
Description
Special Stud
Sawdust Port Cover
Outfeed Shield
Warning Label
Screw, 10-24
Retaining Ring
Tension Screw
Compression Spring
Right End Frame
Latch
Spring
Pivot Screw
Spring Washer
Bearing Support
Space Washer
Lock Washer
Screw
Feed Roller Gear
Prevailing Torque Nut
Thickness Scale
CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
8
513733
Special Washer
50
120380
Lock Washer
73
513381
Sprocket
74
513375
Idler Screw
75
513793
Tapping Screw
76
513368
Bracket
77
120392
Washer, 1/4˝
78
115546
Lock Washer
79
120375
Nut, 1/4˝-20
FEED ASSEMBLY
45
513391
Woodruff Key
49
513191
Socket Hd. Cap Screw
50
120380
Lock Washer
81
51335601
Clamp
82
513743
Handle
83
514690
Feed Motor
84
513406
Screw
85
502973
Lock Washer
86
513735
Retaining Ring
87
513403
Feed Pinion
88
51341503
Gear Cover
89
513411
Safety Key
90
513760
Screw, 10-32
91
514736
Speed Control Box
† Not available as a service part.
Qty.
Price
Each
1
1
1
1
2
1
4
4
1
2
2
2
2
2
8
10
8
2
2
1
$0.80
30.56
31.67
4.80
5.22
0.80
6.25
0.80
2
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
0.80
0.80
1.71
4.80
0.80
4.22
0.80
0.80
0.80
1
4
4
2
2
1
4
4
2
1
1
1
3
1
Pro Planer – Main Assembly
This Parts Lists and Exploded Views supplement the Professional Planer Instruction Manual
(845051). Not all parts are available separately as service parts and may be available only as
part of an assembly. Consult Customer Service.
3.03
0.80
3.00
0.80
0.80
0.80
7.59
0.80
2.46
0.80
0.80
0.80
10.99
6.82
472.37
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.99
14.14
4.52
0.80
364.53
Tips & Techniques
• To make it easier to see the oil hole on the motor
sheave, separate the spring loops, two turns from
the sheave, with a screw driver. Turn the spindle until the hole in the control sheave can be seen and put
two drops of oil in it. Replace the nameplate and the
cover. We can’t stress the importance of this service enough. Cleaning out the sawdust periodically
will prevent your bearings from drying out. Oiling
prevents damage to the speed changer. If you have
trouble changing the speed, or your machine sounds
a little noisy, its time to perform this maintenance.
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
Qty.
1
2
2A
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
14
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
513348
513986
502333
514208
518386
513738
513752
449613
513751
51372304
†
516540
†
513720
513721
513722
†
†
120380
513386
513794
513402
120214
513857
513739
513795
513746
513986
513376
MAIN PLANER ASSEMBLY
Infeed Shield
Screw, 10-32 x 3/8˝
Flat Washer
Feed Rate Label
Outfeed Shield
Screw, 10-24
Retaining Ring
Screw, 8-32
Special Stud
Sawdust Port Cover
Left End Frame
Warning Label
Right End Frame
Latch
Spring
Pivot Screw
Spring Washer
Bearing Support
Lock Washer
Screw, 1/4˝-20
Washer
Feed Roller Gear
Lock Washer
Prevailing Torque Nut
Spacer Washer
Screw
Thickness Scale
Screw, 10-32 x 3/8˝
Tension Screw
1
6
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
6
6
4
2
10
2
8
8
1
2
4
Price
Each
$38.98
0.80
0.80
6.54
31.67
1.56
0.80
0.80
6.25
30.56
4.80
3.03
0.80
3.00
0.80
1.22
0.80
7.59
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
2.46
0.80
6.25
(Continued on next page)
1-800-543-7586
Parts Price List
65
PRO PLANER - STAND MOUNT
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
32
513389
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
513733
120380
513381
513375
513793
513368
120392
115546
120375
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
514203
513191
120380
513391
513406
502973
513735
513403
51341503
513411
513760
514736
Compression Spring
CHAIN TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
Special Washer
Lock Washer
Sprocket
Idler Screw
Tapping Screw
Bracket
Washer, 1/4˝
Lock Washer
Nut, 1/4˝-20
FEED ASSEMBLY
Feed Motor
Screw, 1/4˝-20
Lock Washer
Woodruff Key
Screw
Lock Washer
Retaining Ring
Feed Pinion
Gear Cover
Safety Key
Screw, 10-32
Speed Control Box
Qty.
Price
Each
Ref.
No.
Part No.
Description
4
$0.80
2
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
0.80
0.80
1.71
2.80
0.80
4.22
0.80
0.80
0.80
1
4
4
1
4
4
2
1
1
1
3
1
448.93
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.80
0.99
14.14
4.52
0.80
343.53
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
†
514036
514037
51399401
†
513730
†
†
†
513857
†
51398901
513380
513986
73
74
75
76
77
78
513395
513393
513794
513369
513394
513385
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
—
87
—
514534
513391
555115
†
†
†
†
†
516075
†
†
88
89
90
91
92
93
†
502899
†
513406
513363
505982
94
—
—
—
—
513414
51368601
51368604
51368607
51368605
Table Mounting Post
Table Connector
Barrel Nut
Setscrew
Washer
Tie Bar with Bushings
Shim Washer
Tension Adjustment Sprocket
Roll Pin
Prevailing Torque Nut
Chain
Setscrew
Thickness Pointer
Screw, 10-32 x 3/8˝
ANTI-KICKBACK ASSEMBLY
Anti-kickback Rod
Long Tube Spacer
Washer
Anti-kickback Wedge
Short Tube Spacer
Cotter Pin
FEED ROLLER ASSEMBLIES
Outfeed Roller
Woodruff Key
Infeed Roller
Special Washer
Pivot Screw
Pivot Arm
Washer
Spacer Washer
Cutterhead Assembly
Chip Deflector
Cutterhead Assembly
(includes 88-93)
Cutterhead
Knife Leveling Screw
Ball Bearing
Wedge Locking Screw
Knife Wedge
Knife (set of 3)
Miscellaneous
Knife Setting Gauge
5/32˝ Allen Wrench
3/16˝ Allen Wrench
1/8˝ Allen Wrench
3/32˝ Allen Wrench
† Not available as a service part.
Table, Feed and
Cutterhead Assembly
Qty.
4
4
4
4
8
4
4
4
4
4
1
4
1
1
Price
Each
$37.80
7.16
0.80
38.01
0.80
0.80
6.80
0.80
1
2
2
11
10
1
12.33
1.28
0.80
0.81
0.80
0.80
1
2
1
8
4
4
8
4
53.15
0.80
53.15
385.56
1
1
9
2
24
6
1
0.80
3.20
82.90
1
1
1
1
1
5.82
1.75
1.75
1.75
1.75
0.80
† Not available as a service part.
Tips & Techniques
Ref.
No.
57
58
66
Part No.
Description
†
51413703
†
TABLE ASSEMBLY
Table
Thickness Adjustment
Crank Assembly
Parts Price List
Qty.
Price
Each
1
$38.21
1
• Use Shopsmith Planer Knives (See Page 19).
Other brands of knives will not seat properly in the
cutterhead. Using off-brand knives is extremely
dangerous.
• Your Planer Knives are preset at the factory
and should not require any alignment. However,
you should periodically check and re-check the
condition and alignment of the knives.
www.shopsmith.com
Molding/Shaping
Basics
The Shopsmith Molding Package – Your best choice
for straight-line decorative surfacing or joinery cuts
Molders and Shapers will both elevate your
woodworking projects to a new level of
professionalism. Each is designed to add
decorative or functional touches to the
edges and surfaces of wood – and both
are capable of forming glue joints, drop-leaf
joints, window and door sashes, and a wide
variety of decorative edge treatments.
But, even though the same profiles
are often available for each, there’s a big
difference when it comes to using the tools.
The Molder is used in the Table Saw
position and is best suited for adding
decorative touches to workpiece surfaces.
This application is commonly used with
door and window frame moldings, picture
framing stock, and surface treatments of
furniture components like table aprons or
chair rails.
The Molder’s major limitation is that it’s
only capable of forming profiles in a straight
line ... since all stock must be guided by the
MARK V’s Rip Fence.
The Shaper is used with the Mark V set-up
in the vertical position and is best suited for
shaping the edges of workpieces. In this
mode, the stock is passed by the spinning
cutter – not over it ... and is usually guided
through the process of forming straight or
curved edges by a Shaper Fence or a Rub
Collar with a Starter Pin.
And, since the Shaper is mounted on
the main spindle above the work table, it’s
possible to shape inside edges, too. In both
cases, the large work table surface supports
stock without the need of any special jigs.
To decide which is best for you, look at
the next project you want to build. If you’re
going to be making, plaques, oval or round
picture frames, or kitchen cabinets with
curved rails, get a Shaper. The addition of
decorative edges to these projects would
certainly add a real degree of professionalism
to your work.
If, on the other hand, you plan on making
new trim for a remodeled room, picture
framing stock, or straight decorative moldings
for furniture pieces, select the molder.
1-800-543-7586
C
A
B
While the Dado is perfect for cutting squareA. Smooth-running, wobble-free Steel Molder
edged dadoes or grooves ... and the Shaper is
Head is a heavy-duty model, made of highyour best choice for edging work ... the Molder
quality tool steel. Its unique ball and setscrew
really shines at creating a variety of standard or
alignment system automatically positions the
self-designed decorative patterns or shapes in
Knives during change-over and locks them
the surfaces of workpieces.
in place. Designed to be mounted to the
You’ll use it to create your own unique picture
Shopsmith 5/8˝ Molder/Dado Arbor and
frame designs; to make customized architectural
used with a special Molder Table Insert.
casework or moldings; to reproduce antique
$79.92
505553 Shopsmith Molder
moldings that are either difficult-to-find or no
Head
longer available. The list goes on.
It’s also a great choice for producing a variety
of specialized joints such as: glue joint; tongue- B. Versatile 5/8˝ Molder/Dado Arbor is a great
and-groove; cabinet door panel joints; drop leaf
all-around Arbor for Dado Blades and Molder
table edge joints; and more.
Heads. Having extras allows you to have
a variety of tools ready to go to work on a
Complete Molding Package gives you
moment’s notice ... without bothersome
loads of versatility at a nice savings
change-over.
You’ll get everything you need to add more flair
to your projects. The Package includes:
$27.87
505506 5/8˝ Molder/Dado
• (505553) Steel Molder Head
Arbor
• (505506) 5/8˝ Molder/Dado Arbor
• Molder Table Insert (for your MARK V Model)
C. Molder Table Insert is a requirement when
• (505564) Bead & 1/4-Round Knives
performing Molding operations. Made of high
• (505569) Ogee Knives
quality cast aluminum, they’re heavily ribbed
• (505570) 1/4˝ & 1/2˝ Combo 1/4-Round
for added strength and designed to fit flush
Knives
with the MARK V Work Table surface.
• (505573) 1˝ Flute Knives
$27.71
505622 Molder Insert
• (555038) 3/16˝ Bead & Cove Knives
(Model 500 – bare aluminum)
555173 Molding Package
$208.50
(Model 500)
555153 Molding Package
(Models 505, 510 & 520)
YOU SAVE $11.33
$208.50
555121 Molder Insert
(Models 505, 510,
520/Pro Fence painted red)
Molding
$27.71
67
A full complement of premium Shopsmith Molding
Knives to meet your most exacting requirements
All Shopsmith Molder Knives may be used on any
table saw with a 5/8˝ spindle and a maximum
speed of 4,000 rpm’s.
1.
2.
All Molding Knife Sets (of 3) are
$18.95, unless otherwise specified.
3.
4.
5.
Cloverleaf
3-Bead
Crown
Bead
505560
505561
(Mirror image of 505925)
505562
505563
6.
5/8˝ Cove
505565
11.
Bead & Quarter
Round
Use different combinations of knives
for unique results!
Some knives are designed to do a specific job
like cutting glue joints, door and cabinet lips
and three-bead moldings.
Others, however, are described as combination
cutters and are usually set to shape a portion of
the final profile.
Here are just a few of the many unique cuts
you can make using Molder Knives in combination.
The numbers inside the Knife shapes in
the below illustrations correspond to the
numbers next to each Knife profile at left.
505564
7.
8.
5/16˝ Cove &
Quarter Round
Flute & Quarter
Round
Cabinet Door
Lip
505566
505567
555588
12.
9.
13.
10.
14.
Ogee
Handrails
505569
15.
Inside Moldings
1/4˝ & 1/2˝
Combination
Quarter Round
Groove
Tongue
505571
505572
(Mirror image of 505572) (Mirror image of 505571)
1˝ Flute
Vee Groove
505573
505574
505570
16.
17.
Glue Joint
1˝ Jointer
555096
505577
18.
Quarter Round
& Cove
505924
21.
22.
19.
20.
3-Flute
Bead & Bevel
505925
(Mirror image of 505561)
505926
23.
24.
Decorative Mold
25.
Picture Frames
Drop-Leaf Cove
Drop Leaf Bead
3/16˝ Bead & Cove
3/16˝ Cove & Bead
1/2˝ Flute
515413 (Mirror
image of 515415)
515415
(Mirror image of
515413)
555038
(Mirror image of 555039)
555039
(Mirror image of
555038)
555040
(Mirror image of
555041)
Threshold
26.
27.
28.
Make beautiful cabinet doors with the Door Panel Cutter and
Door-Rail Coper with your molder
1/2˝ Nosing
3/4˝ Flute
3/4˝ Nosing
555041
(Mirror image of
555040)
555042
(Mirror image of
555043)
555043
(Mirror image of
555042)
68
Molding Knives
Use the Door Panel Cutter to cut the panel grooves in the edge of the rails and stiles.
Cut the ends of the rails with the matching Door-Rail Coper Knife.
555080 Door Panel Molding Knife (Mirror image of 555081)
555081 Door-Rail Coper Molding Knife (Mirror image of 555080)
$18.95
$18.95
www.shopsmith.com
The Shopsmith Shaping Package – Helps you create
beautiful decorative trim on curved or straight edges
A
D
B
C
While the Molder produces great straight-line
cuts in the surfaces of workpieces ... and the
Dado is the tool to reach for when you need
square-edged dadoes or grooves ... the Shaper
is best for decorating edges or making edge
joints on straight or curved edges.
In fact, Rub Collars and Starting Pins let the
Shaper tackle irregular shaped edges as easily
as regular ones. PLUS – the Shaper even lets
you work on the inside edges of cut-outs such
as round or oval picture frames.
And, like its Molding cousin, it’s a great
choice for producing specialized joints such as:
glue joint; tongue-and-groove; cabinet door panel
joints; drop leaf table edge joints; and more.
Complete Shaping Package gives you
loads of versatility at a nice savings
The Shopsmith Shaping Package includes:
• Shaper/Drum Sander Fence Kit *
• Shaper Table Insert *
• (555117) Shaper Arbor with Collars
• (505608) 1/4˝ & 1/2˝ Combo 1/4-Round
Cutter
• (505934) Flute & 1/4-Round Cutter
• (505618) 3/16˝ Bead & Cove Cutter
• (555078) Door Panel Shaper Cutter
• (555079) Door-Rail Coper Shaper Cutter
555170 Shaping Package
(Model 500)
$289.77
555141 Shaping Package
(Models 505, 510 & 520)
$289.77
YOU SAVE $19.32
* For your MARK V Model
1-800-543-7586
A. Shaper/Drum Sander Fence Kit – Includes
independently micro-adjustable (to 1/64˝)
infeed/outfeed Fence; Shield; Quill-mounted
Featherguard; Table-mounted Featherboard;
and Vacuum Attachment.
555144 Shaper/Drum
$150.84
Sander Fence Kit
(Model 500)
555113 Shaper/Drum
$150.84
Sander Fence Kit
Over or under-table
Shaping?
With the Shopsmith MARK V Woodworking
System, you have the choice of performing
your Shaping operations from above the
Work Table surface or below it.
The Shaping Package, shown at left, is for
those who prefer the over-table approach to
Shaping. Using this approach, the up-down
depth-of-cut is controlled by your MARK V’s
Quill and your speed is limited to the
MARK V’s maximum 5,200 rpm. As a
result, your final cut may not be as smooth
with over-table Shaping.
The Shopsmith Speed Increaser
See Page 32 allows you to perform undertable Shaping operations at 10,000 rpm’s.
At this speed, you’ll usually achieve a
smoother final cut than with over-table
Shaping. Using this approach, depth-of-cut
is controlled by the up-down motion of your
Work Table. Our Adjustable Stop Collars
See Page 87 will help you make more
finite adjustments.
A few examples of how you
can combine Cutter profiles
to create special shapes
The numbers inside the Cutter shapes in the
below illustrations correspond to the numbers
next to each Cutter profile on page 51.
(Models 505, 510, 520)
B. Table Inserts – Rigid cast aluminum with
21/4˝ diameter circular cutout and two screwin Starter Pins. Accepts Vacuum Attachment.
505509 Shaper/Drum
Drop Leaf Tables
$27.71
Sander Table Insert
(Model 500 – not shown)
555122 Shaper Table Insert
(Models 505, 510, 520)
$27.71
C. 1/2˝ Shaper Arbor – Includes four Rub
Screen Mold
Picture Frames
Collars (25/32˝, 1˝, 11/4˝ and 11/2˝).
555117 1/2˝ Shaper Arbor
$35.79
D. Shaper/Router Shield – See-through Shield
clamps around the MARK V Quill with a single
setscrew and provides both front eye protection and a rear brush that can be adjusted to
meet the top of the Fence or your workpiece
for added dust collection efficiency.
555373 Shaper/Router Shield
$22.27
Table Edges
Shaping
69
A full complement of premium Shopsmith Shaper
Cutters for decorative edging, joinery and more
All Shopsmith Shaper Cutters may be used on any
shaper that accepts 1/2˝ bored Cutters. For safety
reasons, we recommend that these cutters always
be used with a Shaper Fence See Page 69 when
straight-line shaping.
1.
2.
Bead
Crown
505605
505606
All Shaper Cutters are $18.95,
unless otherwise specified.
3.
4.
5.
Bead & Quarter
Round
1/4˝ & 1/2˝
Combination
Quarter Round
Bead & Bevel
505607
505613
505608
6.
7.
Flute & Quarter
Round
8.
1˝ Jointer
9.
Cabinet Door
Lip
505611
505934
10.
Glue Joint
555095
555589
11.
12.
13.
Quarter Round
& Cove
505614
14.
15.
3-Bead Edge
Cloverleaf
Tongue
Groove
1/4˝ Groove
555011
(For use on 3/4˝ stock)
505616
505610
(Mirror image of
505609)
505609
(Mirror image of
505610)
505612
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
Ogee
3/4˝ Flute
3/4˝ Nosing
Vee Groove
1/2˝ Radius
505932
555048 (Mirror
image of 555049)
555049 (Mirror
image of 555048)
505935
555010
21.
22.
23.
Drop-Leaf Cove
Drop Leaf Bead
3/16˝ Bead & Cove
3/16˝ Cove & Bead
1/2˝ Groove
515326
(Mirror image of
515327)
515327
(Mirror image of
515326)
505618
(Mirror image of 555009)
555009
(Mirror image of
505618)
505938
26.
3-Bead
555012 (Mirror
image of 505933)
505933 (Mirror
image of 555012)
70
28.
27.
3-Flute
24.
25.
Oscillating Drum Sander extends Drum
Sleeve life, produces smoother results
and eliminates workpiece burning
This work-saving accessory attaches to your
MARK V (in Drill Press mode) and is powered
solely by its Auxiliary Spindle. Once installed, it
will provide an unassisted, continuous up-down
oscillating action that’s always exposing fresh
abrasives to the wood and cleaning the Sleeve
while you work.
As a result, you’ll spend a lot less time
sanding and produce much smoother results
without having to worry about unsightly abrasive
marking or burning the edges of your stock.
It’s easy ...
Just set your MARK V up for Drill Press operation as you normally would for Drum Sanding.
Clamp the Gearbox Mount around your MARK
V’s Way Tubes, install the Power Coupler,
replace the Quill Handle with the Sander Lever
Arm and attach the Cable.
In less than five minutes, you’ll be ready
to start sanding faster, smoother and more
economically than ever before.
Works with any Shopsmith Drum Sander from
our smallest 1/2˝ by 2˝ Drum to our all-new
21/4˝by 6˝ Drum.
555754 Oscillating Drum
$148.58
Sander
Enjoy added sanding control with our
Drum Sander/Shaper Fence Kits.
See Page 72 for more information
Make beautiful cabinet doors with the
Door Panel Cutter and Door-Rail Coper
with your shaper
Use the Door Panel Cutter to cut the panel grooves
in the edge of the rails and stiles. Cut the ends of
the rails with the matching Door-Rail Coper Knife.
505937 Performs comparably
to the Sash and Door Cutter Kit
555078 Door Panel Shaper Cutter (Mirror image of 555079)
(6 cutters total).
$104.15 555079 Door-Rail Coper Shaper Cutter (Mirror image of 555078)
Complete Cabinet Set
Shaper Cutters
$18.95
$18.95
www.shopsmith.com
Cool off your Disc Sanding and speed-up sandpaper
Disc changes with the Velcro®, Fastening System
C
E
F
G
Get super-smooth results on all of
your projects with our PressureSensitive 12˝ Disc Sanding Package
E. Order this special Package and you’ll never
B
A
again have to fiddle with changing grits in
the middle of a project. You’ll be ready!
You get two extra 12˝ Steel Sanding Discs
plus 18 Pressure-Sensitive, Aluminum Oxide
Sandpaper Discs (six each, Coarse, Medium
and Fine).
$164.75
505844 Disc Sanding Pkg.
YOU SAVE $18.30
F. 12˝ Steel Sanding Disc
555143 12˝ Steel Sanding
$55.60
Disc (1)
A. The Velcro®‚ Disc Sanding Fastening
Pressure-sensitive aluminum oxide
Sandpaper Discs – the great allaround choice for woods and
non-ferrous metals
G. These top-quality Discs feature a durable
Package lets you change from grit-to-grit
in seconds, without solvents or scraping –
PLUS – provides a natural cushion for cooler
sanding, as well.
The complete Velcro Disc Sanding Fastening
Package includes: a 12˝ Velcro Fastening
System Conversion Disc plus two packages
of assorted 12˝ Velcro-Backed A/O Discs.
556120 Velcro Disc Sanding
$69.89
Fastening Package
YOU SAVE $7.76
B. Velcro® Conversion Disc – Self-adhesive on
one side, Velcro on the other.
555102 Velcro Conversion
$20.21
Disc
C. Velcro-Backed Aluminum Oxide Discs
Durable enough to sand wood with loopstyled backs that attach to the conversion
discs above. 6 Discs/package.
555620 Fine – 150-grit
555621 Medium – 100-grit
555622 Coarse – 60-grit
555623 Assorted – (3) Fine, (2) Medium
(1) Coarse)
$28.72 Each
D. Get added dust collection efficiency and support
D
1-800-543-7586
with our Disc Sander Table Insert
Heavy, die-cast aluminum Insert features an
elongated slot with relieved bottom edges that
allow you to tilt the work table for bevel sanding.
NOTE: If you own an old aluminum Sanding Disc,
you’ll need to purchase a Steel Disc (555143,
above). For Models 505, 510 and 520 only.
$27.60
555116 Disc Sander
Table Insert
aluminum oxide abrasive, bonded to a heavy,
industrial-grade pressure-sensitive paper
backing, then precision cut to an exact 12˝.
Six Discs per Package.
505842 Fine – 100-grit
505841 Medium – 80-grit
505840 Coarse – 60-grit
505843 Assorted – (3) Fine, (2) Medium
(1)Coarse
$23.95 Each
Help keep your
shop dust-free
with the Disc
Sander Dust Chute
(Model 500 only) The Dust
Chute comes standard equipment with all
MARK V’s 505, 510 & 520/Pro Fence, and
(555985 & 555142) Table System Retro-Fit
Kits. Not for use with older aluminum Discs.
555167 Disc Sander
$55.95
Dust Chute
Disc Sanding
71
Sand curved or straight...large or small...inside or outside workpiece edges...
...with these great Shopsmith Drum Sanding accessories
F
D
A
E
C
G
B
You get 37 pieces of Drum
Sanding versatility in these
special Packages
Each Package includes Shopsmith’s 2 1/4˝
diameter x 3˝ high Drum Sander; a Drum
Sander/Shaper Table Insert*; a Drum Sander/
Shaper Vacuum Attachment; six assorted
Drum Sander Sleeves; PLUS – Shopsmith’s
complete, 28-piece Extra-Long Drum Sanding
Set (750148). It’s all here!
$108.67
$108.67
555155 Drum Sanding
Package (Models 505, 510, 520)
YOU SAVE $10.71
A. 2 /4˝ Shopsmith Drum Sander – 3˝ high
1
rubber-expansive Drum fits MARK V or
Power Station Spindles, Belt Sander Auxiliary
Spindle. Should always be used with Drum
Sander Table Insert*.
505552 2 1/4˝ x 3˝ Drum
$36.53
Sander
B. 2 1/4˝ x 3˝ Garnet Sanding Sleeves
(Six sleeves per package)
505682 Fine – 100-Grit
505533 Medium – 80-Grit
505532 Coarse – 60-Grit
505531 Assorted (two each grit)
$11.54 Each
72
Vacuum Attachment (D below) to help
channel sawdust away to Dust Collector.
Allows drum to drop below Table surface
for full profile edge sanding.
505509 Drum Sander/Shaper $27.71
Insert (Model 500 – not shown)
555119 Drum Sander Insert
(Models 505, 510, 520)
$27.71
D. Drum Sander/Shaper Vacuum Attachment
* For your MARK V Model
555171 Drum Sanding
Package (Model 500)
C. Drum Sander Table Inserts – Accepts
Drum Sanding
Lets you use your Shopsmith DC3300
Dust Collector See Page 23 to eliminate
workshop dust.
555168 Vacuum Attachment
$11.76
E. Extra-Long Drum Sanding Set tackles large
or small diameter jobs up to 2˝ thick – A
full 28 pieces of Drum Sanding power! The
set starts with four 2˝ high Drums (1/2˝, 3/4˝,
1˝ and 1 1/2˝ diameters) and adds three Fine,
two Medium and one Coarse grit Sleeve for
each size Drum.
750148 Extra-Long Sanding
$32.43
Set
Replacement X-L Sleeve Assortments
Six Fine, four Medium and two Coarse
Sleeves in each 12 Sleeve Assortment.
755037 1/2˝ x 2˝
755039 1˝ x 2˝
755038 3/4˝ x 2˝
755040 11/2˝ x 2˝
$7.84 Each
F. New 6˝ tall Drum provides capabilities you
may never have considered!
21/4˝ diameter rubber expansive Drum does
everything our 3˝ tall model does, and then
some! Sand curved finial shapes on 4˝ x 4˝
deck posts. Pad-Sand a stack of 3/4˝ thick
workpieces all at once. Or ... put a 3˝ tall
Medium Sleeve on top – and a 3˝ tall Coarse
Sleeve on the bottom, then switch grits fast
with your Quill Lever (Vacuum Attachment
must be removed). Includes one Medium 6˝
Sanding Sleeve. Nifty!
555948 2 1/4˝ x 6˝ Drum
$45.86
Sander
Replacement 6˝ x 21/4˝ Sleeves
Six Sleeves per package. Assorted Pack –
two of each grit.
555949 Fine
555950 Medium
555951 Coarse
555952 Assorted
$17.93 Each
G. Abrasive Cleaning Stick – Extends the usable
life of Discs, Belts and Sleeves by up to 400%.
Just hold the 11/2˝ square, 8˝ long Cleaner
against your moving abrasive and watch as
it does its job.
$10.99
753523 Abrasive Cleaning
Stick
Shopsmith Gift Cards
make a great gift!
Order online 24 hours a Day
www.shopsmith.com/ownersite/giftcard/index.htm
www.shopsmith.com
Achieve super-smooth, swirl-free sanding results on even
the most troublesome workpiece edges and surfaces with
the remarkable Shopsmith Conical Sanding Disc
Inflatable Sander uses your MARK V
Lathe to shape or smooth contours
and profiles
High-tech design, high-quality results
4°
FRONT VIEW
TOP VIEW
Astonishing results on
surfaces up to 4˝ wide
The infeed side of the Disc – NOT THE OUTFEED
SIDE – contacts the workpiece’s surface at a
90° angle, parallel to the grain.
• Joint highly figured woods without
tearing or chipping
• Produce glue-quality edges on
sheet goods
• Shave end grains to length with
glass-smooth results
• Achieve precision-ground surfaces
on edged tools
The 4° taper begins 11/4˝ from the center of the
disc and continues to its outside edge. This taper
gives the disc its cone-like shape.
A few years back during an annual inventory, a
Shopsmith engineer pulled a box out of a dark,
neglected corner of the warehouse ... opened it,
and discovered a Conical Sanding Disc made by
Magna Engineering (the original manufacturer of
Shopsmith equipment).
Lucky for all of us, he had used a Disc just
like this at a woodworking company where he
had been employed several years earlier, recalled
its incredible capabilities and set out on a
“mission” to bring this extremely versatile
product back to the market.
Since then, we’ve sold thousands of these
amazing Discs and all who use them continue
to sing their praises.
How does it work?
The heavy steel Disc is made with a precise,
4° tapered, cone-like shape. When using it, the
MARK V’s Table is tilted to that same 4° angle
and a Rip Fence or Miter Gauge used as a guide
to keep the stock moving in a straight line.
As the stock is moved past the Disc, a narrow
band (less than 1/4˝ wide) is created where the
full workpiece edge (up to 4˝ tall) is in contact
with the abrasives.
Within this band, all of the abrasive materials and the workpiece edge move parallel with
one another and in opposing directions. This
is straight-line abrasion in its purest sense. No
wonder there are no swirl marks. It’s magic!
1-800-543-7586
Puts a glass-smooth, glue quality
finish on even the most difficult edges
No edge is too uneven or tough. Unlike your
Jointer, the Conical Disc will shave the edges
of highly figured birdseye or BURL woods without tearing or chipping. Where materials such
as plywoods, particleboard, MDF and plastic
laminate-covered composites will eat up Jointer
knives, they’re no problem for the Conical Disc.
Remove up to 1/8˝ in a single pass!
A 1/8˝ pass across the edge of composites
and highly figured woods is almost certain
to produce undesirable results. NOT with the
Conical Sanding Disc. Grab a 2˝ x 2˝ piece of
figured wood or composite, make your set-up
for a 1/8˝ pass according to your Disc Manual,
follow all operational and safety instructions and
shove it through. WOW!
$69.39
555477 Conical Disc Sanding
Pkg. (Includes Disc and Assorted Disc Pack)
YOU SAVE $7.59
555435 Conical Sanding
$58.09
Disc (only)
Conical Sandpaper Discs
Pressure-sensitive aluminum
oxide Discs. Three per
package. Assorted Pack
includes one each 50, 80
and 150-grit Discs.
555430 50-Grit
555431 80-Grit
555433 150-Grit
555434 Assorted (One Ea. – 50, 80 & 150-Grit A/O Discs)
$18.89 Each
Just mount this 21/4˝ diameter x 8˝˝ long sander
between the centers of your MARK V’s Lathe
(Tailstock Live Center, 505602 required for use,
see Page 78 and inflate it to the pressure you
want (up to 15# psi) with a bicycle pump. Sands
flat surfaces (at max inflation) or contoured
shapes (at low pressure) with equal ease.
High-quality construction with metal ends and
canvas-over-rubber drum. Includes one 100grit/medium aluminum oxide sleeve.
$75.17
754200 Contour Sanding Drum
Aluminum Oxide Replacement Sanding
Sleeves (5 sleeves per pack)
754201 Coarse – 80-grit
754202 Medium – 100-grit
521760 Fine – 120-grit
754203 Ultra-Fine – 150-grit
$22.34 Each
Cut your sanding time in half and
achieve smoother surfaces with
these versatile Hand Scrapers
Hand Scrapers will remove materials much
faster than sandpaper and, at the same time,
eliminate uneven spots that abrasive materials
will only tend to magnify. In addition to their
superior smoothing qualities, they will also
prove most useful in removing old finishes and
glue with incredible ease and precision.
This complete set includes a rectangular
scraper, a concave/convex scraper, and a
“goose-neck” scraper for moldings and shaped
edges of all types.
518666 Set of 3 Hand Scrapers
Conical Sanding
$14.39
73
The last word in quality wood boring Drill Bits
When boring holes in wood, always use a wood bit!
Here’s why Brad Point Bits are
the Pro’s choice:
• A super-sharp point at the tip locates
the hole with unwavering precision,
then “bites-in” to hold the bit on center
as it advances, guaranteeing “on-target”
hole location.
• The two side spurs slice cleanly through
the wood fibers making a perfectly round,
splinter-free entry and exit, while the
precision-ground edges shave the hole side
clean. Deep chip channels quickly eject the
chips.
• High quality carbon alloy steel holds its
edge while radiused step adds strength
and durability.
specifications from high quality carbon alloy
steel to take and hold a keen cutting edge
under heavy use. All Bits are 5 1/2˝ long and
those above 1/2˝ diameter feature 1/2˝ shanks.
The quality Hardwood Case (with polyurethane
finish) features a form-fitting slot for each Bit.
Brad Point Bits are your best choice for most
woodworking applications: Boring holes for
dowels or round tenons; Pilot holes for screws
or bolts; Counterbores. Whenever you need a
clean hole, you need a Brad Point Drill Bit.
These bits are manufactured to our exacting
Alternate
Set
Completer
Set
Super
Set
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
PRICE PER SET
555417
$57.41
555415
$86.82
505905
$137.75
555416
$267.21
YOU SAVE
$7.13
$3.70 $14.25 $12.98
Part #
555016
505879
505880
505881
505882
505883
505884
505885
505886
505887
505888
505889
505890
505891
505892
74
Size
1/8˝
3/16˝
1/4˝
5/16˝
3/8˝
7/16˝
1/2˝
9/16˝
5/8˝
11/16˝
3/4˝
13/16˝
7/8˝
15/16˝
1˝
Basic
Set
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Brad Point Drill Bits
Retail
$6.64
$8.18
$8.18
$9.23
$10.25
$11.54
$13.77
$12.70
$14.92
$15.80
$17.42
$19.88
$22.06
$25.80
$26.81
Shopsmith Brad Points are available
individually or one of four sets, as
described in the chart at the bottom
left. All bits above 1/2˝ have 1/2˝ shanks.
Form perfect screw head recesses
with this single-fluted, quickcutting, 3-piece Countersink Set
Use this set of three single-flute, precision
ground cutters to recess the heads of screws
and bolts flush with the surface.
Includes: 1/4˝, 1/2˝ and 5/8˝ diameters
to cover the smallest to largest screwheads.
German-made for use with portable electric
drills or drill presses. All have 1/4˝ shanks.
722016 3-piece Countersink
$26.19
Set
www.shopsmith.com
Amazingly versatile, they’re the world’s
most unique bits!
Work easier and safer with these
three great drilling accessories
A
C
B
A. 3-Lever Drill Press Quill Handle for
more leverage, control and convenience
Ergonomically correct Handle attaches to
either side of the MARK V Headstock to
give you the maximum leverage and comfort without “over-reaching” when Drilling,
Drum Sanding, Routing or Shaping.
Forstner bits are designed to handle tasks that
other bits just can’t tackle. First, they have
practically no center spur, so they’re ideal for
boring almost perfectly flat-bottomed holes like
those found in holders for candles or salt and
pepper shakers – or, hollowing out small,
circular boxes for rings, jewelry, etc.
Thanks to the small spur, you can use most
forstners to drill to within 1/32˝ of the bottom
of your workpiece without fear of the center
spur chewing through the wood.
They’re also great for boring exceptionally
clean angled holes or overlapping holes; for
re-locating an existing hole by enlarging it; for
making round-end mortises; for drilling into
end grain; and for drilling larger diameter
holes in extremely thin stock, such as veneers,
without splitting.
Furthermore, because of their unique design,
they won’t “wander” off center, even through
knots, bird’s-eyes, and irregular grains. In short,
they do all the things most bits can’t do.
Forstner bits are available in four individual
sizes or a complete set for additional savings.
All bits offer a 5/16˝ shank. Each is 31/2˝ long
overall. Definitely, the most versatile and
convenient drill bits you could ever own!
720015 3/8˝ Forstner Bit
720016 1/2˝ Forstner Bit
720017 5/8˝ Forstner Bit
720018 3/4˝ Forstner Bit
720019 7/8˝ Forstner Bit
720020 1˝ Forstner Bit
555749 Forstner Bit Package
Includes all 6 bits above
YOU SAVE $15.45
$10.36
$11.38
$13.61
$14.81
$15.84
$18.07
$68.62
555491 3-Lever Drill Press
$30.19
Handle
B. Precision Drill Chuck and Key
For MARK V or any 5/8˝ lathe spindle.
1/2˝ shank capacity.
505633 Drill Chuck w/Key
$40.49
C. Tailstock Chuck Arbor – Used for center
drilling lamp standards and the ends of
workpieces mounted to the MARK V’s
driven spindle. #2 Morse Taper end slips
into MARK V’s Lathe Tailstock. Drill Chuck
mounts on opposite end.
505603 Tailstock Chuck
$20.78
Arbor
Breathable Machine Cover protects
your MARK V from condensation
and damaging rust
This rugged, cotton/polyester cover is customsewn to the shape of your Shopsmith MARK V.
The special urethane coating repels moisture
while a unique perforation process allows
any moisture that might get in from below to
escape, preventing rust and corrosion.
515306 MARK V Cover
Models 500, 505, 510 & 520
1-800-543-7586
Drilling
$40.94
75
Versatile, Multi-Purpose Drill Press/Bench Vise comes
With mounting hardware for your MARK V Work Table
• Quick-Release
Jaws
• Drill Press or
Bench Mount
• Rugged Steel
and Aluminum
Construction
• A Must-Have
Accessory
Occasionally, a product comes along that’s so
handy, it’s tough to do without. This is one of
those products. Most vises that are worth their
salt can cost upwards of $100, and then, all
you usually get is either a Bench Vise OR a
Drill Press Vise.
However, with this one Vise, you get both.
As a Drill Press Vise, it mounts directly to the
Miter Gauge Slots in your MARK V Work Table
with two Sliding T-Nuts, Buttonhead Bolts and
Fender Washers (included).
You’ll reach for it whenever you need to hold
workpieces for drilling or routing operations. As
a Bench Vise, you can clamp it onto any surface
up to 21/2˝ thick in a vertical, horizontal, 45° or
even upside-down position to hold any object up
to its 4˝ jaw opening.
Stationary 13/8˝h x 37/8˝w Jaw features both
vertical and horizontal V-Slots for gripping round
or odd-shaped objects. Just depress the quickrelease button on top and the movable Jaw
slides open in a single, quick action.
Includes Vise, Bench Clamp, two Sliding
T-Nuts (514491), two Buttonhead Bolts and two
Fender Washers for MARK V mounting.
556416 Bench/Drill Press Vise
$59.64
Flip-up Rip Fence Stop ensures
precise repeatability at up
to 32˝ from center
Here’s the perfect accessory for repetitive
drilling operations or for controlling “stopped”
operations such as dadoes, grooves, bandsaw
cuts or decorative molding and routing operations.
Just attach the aluminum Extension Rail to
the top of your MARK V’s (505, 510 or 520) or
later model Bandsaw Rip Fence and lock it into
position with a quick twist of the Knob. The
special extension Rail includes two built-in
washers to hold the Rail parallel when it’s
extended beyond the end of your Rip Fence.
You’ll get a full 32˝ of adjustment from the
center of a Model 510 Work Table (31˝ on a
Model 520).
Then, slide the Flip-Up Stop onto the Rail and
twist the Locking Knob. Flippers are reversible
to work on either side of the Fence. Order extra
Flippers for multiple stops.
555807
Flip-Up Rip Fence Stop
$44.09
Models 505, 510 & Bandsaw Fence
555808
Flip-Up Rip Fence Stop
$44.09
Model 520 Only
52170801 Flip Stop
$14.27
Models 505, 510 & Bandsaw Fence
52170802 Flip Stop
$14.27
Model 520 Only
Plug Cutters help you cover unsightly
screwheads with matching wood
45° Angle
On Bench
Off Bench
90°Angle
Shopsmith’s T-Track Utility Light sheds light on close-up work
This special Fence Light Kit includes a Shopsmith
Utility Light (555503) and a special bracket for
mounting it quickly to the T-Track on the top of
your MARK V’s Rip Fence or the T-Slots in your
work table surface (Models 510 or 520 only).
Can also be used with later model Shopsmith
Bandsaws and Bandsaw Fences, and the
Shopsmith MARK V Router Table Kit. Just slide
the bracket into position and lock with a quick
twist to hold and aim your Utility Light exactly
where you need it.
555806 T–Track Utility Light Kit
Includes Utility Light and Bracket
$71.30
521787 T-Tract Light Support
$22.22
Bracket Only
76
Drilling
Exposed screwheads can spoil the appearance
of an otherwise spectacular project. You can
make your own plugs out of the very same wood
you’re using for your project; and they’ll match
so perfectly they’ll become practically invisible!
This set of three Cutters will create tapered,
easy-to-insert 1/4˝, 3/8˝ and 1/2˝ plugs up to
1˝ long. German-made, they all feature 1/4˝
shanks. Recommended for use in drill presses.
522477 3-Piece Tapered Plug
$27.99
Cutter Set
www.shopsmith.com
Turn beautiful, perfectly-matched spindles or bowls
with the easy-to-use Shopsmith Lathe Duplicator
Adjustable, See-Through Lathe Shield
Protect your eyes from flying chips and debris
during turning with this 12 5/8˝ x 11˝ impactresistant, see-through Shield. Attach the
Mounting Support Bracket to the back side of
your MARK V’s Headstock (hardware included),
slide the Gooseneck’s notched end over the
Bracket and go to work.
The complete Kit includes the See-Through
Shield, 24˝ Gooseneck Arm with attached, slipon Mounting End, Support Bracket, Mounting
Hardware and full instructions. Order extra
Support Brackets for your other machines.
522198 See-Through
$54.27
Lathe Shield
$4.55
555520 Extra Support Bracket
With hardware
Duplicator Steady Rest
Now you can quickly and easily make multiple
spindle or faceplate turnings that match perfectly. Create chair backs, newel posts and stair
railings. Turn matched sets of bowls or round
gift boxes. Duplicate pieces up to 8˝ in diameter
with cuts to 31/4˝ deep! Work with flat patterns
or existing turnings such as worn or broken
porch spindles.
A simple Micro-adjustment assures Cutting
Tip to Follower Tip alignments as close as 1/64˝.
Then just grasp the Floating Tool Rest Assembly
(which holds the Cutting and Follower Tips)
firmly with both hands, and glide it smoothly
across the Work Table surface while the
Follower Tip traces the pattern and the Cutting
Tip does the work. Simple!
The two-handed grip gives you positive
control of every cut. Use the Follower Tip when
duplicating, or remove it and turn free-hand
without fear of gouging or snagging.
The rugged Work Table mounts in your MARK
V’s Table Carriage. Heavy steel supports clamp
quickly to the MARK V’s upper way tubes to
hold the pattern securely. Includes Safety Guard
and 12˝ wide, clear Chip Deflector Shield for
added safety. Folds for compact storage.
1-800-543-7586
Standard Accessories:
Mounting Brackets with Unistrut® Support Bar
60° Triangle Cutter and Follower
12˝ Floating Chip Shield
Floating Tool Rest Assembly
Heavy-Duty Work Table Assembly
Two Reversible Pattern Clamps
Live Center Extension Spacer (optional
Tailstock Live Center is not included, but
recommended). See Page 78
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Specifications
Maximum length of workpiece ...................... 34˝
Recommended when turning long or small diameter
spindles to eliminate whip,
chatter and vibrations.
Assures a smoother finish with less chance of
workpiece breakage. Fully adjustable. Accepts
stocks with diameters from 3/16˝ to 31/2˝ in dia.
Permanently lubricated ball bearing.
555639 Lathe Duplicator
$54.18
Steady Rest
1/2˝ Cone Cutter/Follower
Precision-ground, highspeed steel with extrasharp edge for fine,
smooth shaving cuts in
both soft and hardwoods.
555278 1/2˝ Cone Cutter/
$14.51
Follower
Cutter Profiles and matching
Follower Tips
Maximum length of turning .......................... 32˝
Minimum length of workpiece
With standard Cup Center....................... 6 1/4˝
With Live Center and spacer ................... 4 1/4˝
Maximum turning diameter
from a flat template ......................................... 8˝
Maximum turning diameter
from 3-dimensional pattern ............................. 4˝
555638 Shopsmith Lathe
$461.99
Duplicator
Includes: Standard Accessories, including
one 60° Triangle Cutting Tip
The Shopsmith Lathe Duplicator is a
Special Truck Shipment item and requires
an additional $15 shipping fee.
555213 35° Diamond Cutter - For turning
fine beads of deep, intricate detail.
$24.81
555211 60° Triangle Cutter - Universal tip,
from rough turning through medium details.
Comes standard with Lathe Duplicator.
555210 1/2˝ Round - For initial roughing/
forming curves and coves.
555212 3/8˝ Square - For turning long, flat
surfaces, dowels and plugs.
$24.81 Each
Lathe Duplicator
77
Shopsmith’s Lathe Chisels, Faceplates and Centers
The tools you need to start building your turning skills
A
L
B
C
D
E
F
I. Lathe Live Center eliminates workpiece
burning – Friction-free, ball bearing construction allows the tip to rotate freely without the
need for beeswax or similar lubricants. Fits
any #2 Morse Taper Tailstock.
505602 Tailstock Live Center $41.99
J. Lathe Screw Center is ideal for small
N
K
turnings – Especially designed for turning
small diameter workpieces from 1˝ to 5˝ long
without using a Tailstock Center.
505601 Lathe Screw Center
$24.57
Lathe Faceplates provide wobblefree support for turning bowls, etc.
I
J
H
M
G
Shopsmith’s Lathe Turning Package is a great Starter Set & a nice value, too!
$201.23
505754 Lathe Turning
Start with our 5-Piece Lathe Chisel Set; add
both of our Lathe Faceplates, a Lathe Screw
Center, a Tailstock Live Center, and a Tailstock
Chuck Arbor.
A. Shopsmith’s 5-Piece Lathe Chisel Package
handles all your basic turning needs
Made of premium-quality, high-speed steel,
Shopsmith’s Lathe Chisels will take and
hold a keen cutting edge under hard use.
Comfortable hardwood handles are a joy
to hold.
Package includes:
• 1˝ Skew with a straight, slanted edge
for cutting beads, smoothing and
forming round shapes.
• 3/8˝ and 1˝ Gouges for cutting coves and
roughing stock to make it round.
• 1/2˝ Parting Tool for grooving, cutting
shoulders, sizing cuts and separating your
project from the scrap.
• 1/2˝ Roundnose for bowls and other
faceplate-mounted projects.
505586 5-Piece Lathe
$93.75
Chisel Package
B.
C.
D.
E.
F.
78
YOU SAVE $9.52
Individual Lathe Chisels
$19.73
515030 Parting Tool
$19.73
515028 3/8˝ Gouge Chisel
515029 1/2˝ Roundnose
$19.73
Chisel
515027 1˝ Gouge Chisel
$22.04
515026 1˝ Skew Chisel
$22.04
Turning
Package
YOU SAVE $17.01
G. Lathe Drive Center grips your turnings
securely – Four-spur Center “drives” your
workpiece during lathe operations. Just use
a mallet to drive the spurs into the centerpoint of your stock and attach it to the
MARK V spindle with a single setscrew.
Standard with MARK V.
505715 Lathe Drive Center
$29.99
H. Lathe Cup Center supports non-driven end
of spindles while turning – Designed
for use on the Shopsmith MARK V or any
tailstock having a #2 Morse Taper. Allows
workpiece to spin freely when powered by
the Drive Center. Standard with MARK V.
$18.47
505716 Lathe Cup Center
Feature multiple holes for mounting different
sized turning blanks. Mount to MARK V or any
5/8˝ diameter spindle with single setscrew.
K. 505590 3 3/4˝ Faceplate
$24.99
L. 505591 6˝ Dia. Faceplate
$31.99
M. Tailstock Chuck Arbor lets you center-drill
turned spindles – Use for center drilling
lamp standards and the ends of workpieces
mounted to the MARK V’s driven spindle.
#2 Morse Taper end slips into MARK V’s
Lathe Tailstock. Drill Chuck mounts on
opposite end.
$20.78
505603 Tailstock Chuck
Arbor
N. Double-Stick Tape holds small diameter
turnings to your Shopsmith Faceplates
This special, 1˝ wide, high-adhesion tape has
amazing gripping power!
Caution: Always use a clamp or vise to apply
sufficient pressure to ensure a good bond
between the Faceplate and the workpiece.
Do not turn an excessively long workpiece or
one that is more than 11/2 times the diameter
of the Faceplate. Failure to ensure a good
bond or turning a workpiece that’s too large
could result in personal injury.
$10.43
755007 Double-Stick Tape
O. Outside Caliper is a real must for lathe
O
P
turners – Use for duplicating measured
spindle cuts and gauging the thickness
of bowl walls.
730221 Outside Caliper
$23.09
P. Precision tool locates the exact center
of turning stock in seconds – Works with
round, square, hexagonal or octagonal
stock. Center cutout allows marking.
$11.06
731195 Center Finder
www.shopsmith.com
Enjoy better Chisel control and results with these Specialty Tool Rests
A
B
C
D
D
A
C
B
Includes: A. 4˝ Tool Rest, B. “S”-Shaped Tool
Rest and C. 90° Tool Rest, at right. All will fit
any tool rest supports having a 3/4˝ post.
555315 Specialty Tool
$81.05
Rest Package
YOU SAVE $5.34
Specialty Lathe Chisel Sets for Spindle, Bowl and Small Hollow Turning
Lathe Chisel Sets allow greater flexibility in your turning projects. They are made from high-speed
steel, have seasoned Ash handles, contoured to
fit comfortably in the hand, and give the correct
balance to the woodturner.
A. 4˝ Lathe Tool Rest is great for smaller
turning jobs
Get in closer to deep coves on spindles or
bowls and to reach farther into bowls when
hollowing.
555314 4˝ Lathe Tool Rest
$23.51
B. Better bowls with S-Shaped Tool Rest
Lets you reach up to 4˝ deep into a bowl,
while conforming to a typical inside shape.
6 ˝ long, heavy-duty cast iron.
555312 Bowl Tool Rest
$34.19
Miniature Hollow
Forming Set
Bowl Turning Set
6-Piece Spindle Turning Set
This set of six tools embodies all of the essential
tools required for between center work. This
set includes a 3/4˝ Roughing Out Gouge, a 3/8˝
Spindle Gouge, a 1˝ Oval Skew Chisel, a 1/2˝
Roundnose Scraper, a 3/16˝ Parting Tool, and
a 3/8˝ Bedan.
518734 Spindle Turning
$157.49
Tool Set
C. 90° Tool Rest for faceplate turnings
Perfect for turning bowls, goblets, vases
and projects where you make flowing,
continuous cuts from outside surfaces
to inside surfaces.
555313 90° Tool Rest
$28.69
4-Piece Bowl Turning Set
Made to the same specifications and materials
as the Spindle Turning Set above, this essential set of four tools is required to turn bowls.
Includes a 3/8˝ Bowl Gouge, a 1/2˝ Bowl Gouge,
a 1˝ Shear Scraper, and a 11/4˝ Bowl Scraper.
518733 Bowl Turning Tool Set
$139.33
D. Lathe Steady Rest for added stability
Reduce whip, chatter and possible stock
breakage when turning long spindles or thin
diameter stock. Accepts stock from 3/16˝ to
31/2˝ diameter. Ball bearing construction.
555280 Lathe Steady Rest
$85.04
1-800-543-7586
Pen Turning Set
Miniature Hollow Forming Set
The perfect set for turning small bowls
and hollow pieces.
518823 Miniature Hollow
Form Tool Set
$65.76
Spindle
Turning Set
Pen Turning Set
Wood Turning
Mini Set
This 3-piece set is ideal for the serious pen
turner. The continental shape 1/2˝ Roughing
Out Gouge is made from high-speed steel.
Also included is the new, innovative 1/4˝
mini 9-in-1 tool and a 1/16˝ Parting Tool.
518908 Pen Turning Set
$46.17
Wood Turning Mini Set
This handy 5-piece set is ideal for lace bobbins,
miniature turning, chess pieces, and other small
items where large tools may get in the way.
This set includes a 1/4˝ Mini Roughing
Gouge, a 1/8˝ Mini Roughing Gouge, a Mini
Roundnose, Mini Skew and Mini Parting Tool.
518840 Wood Turning Mini Set
Lathe Tool Rests/Lathe Chisel Pkgs.
$82.72
79
Massive, 35-pound Universal Lathe Tool
Rest will do more to improve your turning
results than any other lathe tool
Tool Rest Upgrade Kit
Adjusts quickly
without an
Allen wrench
All-new design
lets you adjust the
position of your lathe
tool rest as the turning
material profile changes. All adjustments are
accomplished by handoperated Levers that pivot and swing to where
you need them. This upgrade is particularly
helpful for bowl turners.
Upgrade Kit includes: Tool Rest Arm, setscrew, Upper and Lower Levers, warning label
and instruction sheet.
521765 Lathe Tool Rest
$23.89
Upgrade Kit
For Model 500 – Arm not included.
$38.05
514264 Lathe Tool Rest
Upgrade Kit
Reaches around the back side of faceplate turnings with ease
(right top), and provides up close support, deep inside the
deepest bowls (right bottom).
Shopsmith’s new Universal Lathe Tool Rest is
the most stable, most versatile lathe tool rest
you’ll find anywhere – period! Its unique “triplejointed” design lets you swing the arm and
support in any direction to position your tool rest
deep within the deepest bowls, vases or goblets.
This heavy, cast iron Tool Rest System gives
you all the solid lathe tool support and “reach”
you’ll ever need. You’ll quickly “hog-out” huge
amounts of waste or delicately produce intricate
designs with equal ease and assured supersmooth results every time.
No more annoying vibrations, chatter or tool
rest flexing. Whether you’re turning with a
faceplate, chuck or between centers, the added
mass and adjustment flexibility of this System
will make a big difference in your turning results
from now on.
Easy to attach and easier to use
Simply remove your MARK V’s Work Table from
the Table Carriage, set the 10˝ diameter by 1˝
thick cast iron Mounting Plate on top of the
Carriage, tighten the two bolts and go to work.
A quick twist of the locking lever loosens the
18 1/4˝ long Support Base Arm. Rotate it a full
360°, move it left or right and lock it firmly at
any point along its 7 3/8˝ of travel.
Slip the rotating Tool Support Arm into the
Support Base Arm and lock it into position with
another quick-acting lever. The rugged 1˝ dia.
steel post in the Support Arm gives you a full
2 1/8˝ of up-down travel, allowing you to position
Shopsmith’s standard Tool Rest from 1/2˝ below
to 11/2˝ above your workpiece centerline. An
adjustable stop collar and height setscrew lets
80
Lathe Tool Rests
For Models 505, 510 & 520
Non-toxic finishes for
toys and eating utensils
you return to a pre-set height instantly.
Any of the four available Shopsmith Tool Rests
(or our Lathe Steady Rest) lock into the Tool
Support Arm with a convenient third lever.
This revolutionary System gives
everything you need to achieve
improved results
You’ll get the 10˝ diameter by 1˝ thick Mounting
Base with precision machined Support Base
bearing surfaces; the rigid, 18 1/4˝ x 13/8˝ x 21/2˝
Support Base Arm with a 7 3/8˝ travel slot for
wide-ranging adjustments; the 43/8˝ x 11/2˝ steel
Tool Support Arm with 1˝ diameter steel mounting post and adjustable depth-stop collar; three
Locking Levers for quick adjustments; and all
necessary mounting hardware. Fits MARK V
Models 500, 505, 510 and 520.
555811 Universal Lathe
$198.44
Rest System
Salad Bowl Finish is non-toxic and designed
primarily for wooden items that come in regular
contact with food and food products. It has
been designed to produce a harder finish than
Preserve. Can be buffed to a high-gloss finish
and is dishwasher safe (16 ounces).
Preserve is a non-toxic finish containing a
rare blend of oils extracted from the meats of
exotic nuts. It penetrates deeply into the fibers
of woods to keep the juices and odors of foods
from ruining wooden items used in the kitchen.
Leaves a soft feel and luster (8 ounces).
$10.49
945402 Salad Bowl Finish
521246 Preserve Oil Finish
$10.49
All-Inclusive Lathe Tool Rest Package
Includes: A. Universal Lathe Tool Rest System
(555811)
B. S-Shaped Lathe Tool Rest (555312)
C. 90° Lathe Tool Rest (555313)
D. 4˝ Lathe Tool Rest (555314)
See Page 79 Total Value: $284.83
555868 All Inclusive Lathe
$253.56
B
C
D
A
Tool Rest Package
YOU SAVE $31.27
www.shopsmith.com
Lathe Chuck Systems
Attach and detach turnings much faster and more conveniently
1-800-543-7586
Lathe Chuck Systems
81
D
Put the two-way-squeeze on large assembled panels with our
Double Bar Clamps and get a flat, tight glue-up every time!
Whenever you’re making those really big
projects – table tops, doors, countertops,
desks, cabinets, shelving, or any other job
requiring gluing two or more pieces of stock
together you need our Double Bar Clamps.
There just isn’t any better way to keep your long
stock from bowing – the major problem with
these workpieces.
The bars of these unique clamps are made
from the highest quality hardwoods. Each bar is
professionally milled to provide superior clamping
on a full range of widths. When gluing pieces
edge-to-edge, these clamps apply pressure
from the sides, top and bottom simultaneously.
Dual clamping action
B
Simple to use
Simply place your glued pieces between the
wood bars and hand tighten the wing nut.
The Double Bar Clamps go to work, applying
pressure along the length of the glued pieces.
The pressure is firm and uniform as the clamps
grip the work.
A. 555162 24˝ Clamp
$57.84
10 ˝ minimum width
A
C
The secret to the special dual channel clamping
action is the ingenious curved radius of each
hardwood bar. This precision cut radius distributes pressure equally over the entire width of
the project. No other clamp works with this level
of precision. Your workpiece glues up evenly
and tightly – eliminating the need for tedious
82
surface sanding or planing. By using our Double
Bar Clamps, you’ll end up with a project you’ll
be proud to have in your home.
Each clamp is fully adjustable to varying
lengths of stock for a wide variety of woodworking projects. Even smaller projects have
a better chance of turning out the way you
want them to ... when you have these Double
Bar Clamps in your bag of workshop tricks.
Clamping Solutions
B.
555163 36˝ Clamp
15 1/4˝ minimum width
$69.39
C.
555164 48˝ Clamp
22 1/2˝ minimum width
$77.19
555800 24˝ Clamp
Set of three
$156.94
YOU SAVE $16.58
555801 36˝ Clamp
Set of three
E. Light weight Cam Clamps are real work
savers – These European-style Cam Clamps
feature hardwood jaws with protective cork
faces. Sliding freely along rigid, lightweight
steel bars, the jaws lock firmly in position
with up to 300 lbs. of clamping force with
a quick flip of the wooden cam lever. Sizes
indicated below are jaw length x bar length.
518506 4 1/2˝ x 16˝ Cam Clamp
$17.59
$176.79
YOU SAVE $31.38
555802 48˝ Clamp
Set of three
$188.99
YOU SAVE $42.58
www.shopsmith.com
The world’s most versatile
Shop Apron!
This 100% fully washable cotton-canvas Shop
Apron is the most versatile apron available today.
Made in the USA, the slip-over design has fully
adjustable 1˝ wide nylon web shoulder straps,
and an adjustable (to 52˝ waist) 11/2˝ wide nylon
web belt with a quick release buckle.
This unique apron has 20 variable-sized
pockets from a pocket for your pencil to a huge
61/4˝ square, plus two rugged, 11/2˝ wide nylon
web tool loops.
521802 World’s Most Versatile
$44.28
Shop Apron
Budget-priced blue denim Apron
protects your clothes and carries
your tools, too
3-Way Clamps help you attach
veneer tapes and decorative
edging to shelves, cabinets, etc.
24˝ Magnetic Tool Bar holds 20 lbs.
of tools per running inch!
Two adjustable, opposing jaws open to a full
2 1/2˝ and a third jaw can be centered over any
edge with up to 2˝ of throat depth. Buy them
in sets of four at a nice savings.
$10.99
742031 3-Way Edging Clamp
555803 Set of four 3-Way
$37.49
Edging Clamps
Hammers, ratchets, open |end wrenches,
chisels, pliers – this bar will hold them all
without dropping. Made of heavy-gauge
enameled steel. Measures 24˝ x 13/16˝ x 11/8˝
with two welded-on hanging brackets, spaced
16˝ on centers to line up with wall studs.
Screws included.
YOU SAVE $6.47
1-800-543-7586
942101 Magnetic Tool Bar
$22.04
Full-length, 28˝ x 36˝ washable denim shop
apron. Navy blue with a red Shopsmith logo.
The big 15˝ x 6˝ covered pocket holds tools.
555208 Shopsmith Apron
✍
$17.42
I really love the quality you folks
build into your equipment.
~ G. Randal, South Harswell, ME
Clamping Solutions
83
Protect and maintain your valuable tool investment
with these Be Prepared products
Information-packed, 10 lesson course
C
Beginners and experienced woodworkers alike
will quickly find their own starting points ... then
advance at a chosen pace toward the level they
want to achieve ... creating wonderful projects
for family and friends along the way.
A
B
505717 MARK V Self-Study
$90.68
Course
D
Update your MARK V skills
Be ready for lost parts and minor
problems with the Help Kit
Over 60 pieces, including the most frequently
lost setscrews plus lubricants, shop rags and
the following: 5/32˝ Allen wrench; (18) assorted
shims; (20) 5/16˝-18 x 1/4˝ setscrews; (6)
5/16˝-18 by 3/8˝ setscrews; (2) tapered,
5/16˝-18 Miter Gauge Bar setscrews; (5)
straight, 5/16˝-18 setscrews; (5) flat-head
Table Insert setscrews; (1) 1/4˝-20 Round
head setscrews; 5.5 oz. aerosol, Top-Cote;
pocket oiler; (2) shop rags; MARK V Alignment
and Instruction Manual.
A.
B.
515325 Shopsmith Help Kit
942328 5/32˝ T-handle Hex
$34.70
$5.76
Wrench
purchased prior to 10/01/01)
The 4th edition of Shopsmith’s
own 325-page hardbound
book is a “powerhouse” of
woodworking knowledge.
Power Tool Woodworking
for Everyone includes new
chapters on accessories
and updates on all other
chapters. It includes a host of troubleshooting
charts, conversion tables and lots more.
555751 Shopsmith Black
555069 Power Tool
Touch-Up Paint
Shopsmith matching touch-up paint (12 oz.)
keeps your Shopsmith tools looking like new.
C. 522142 Shopsmith Gray (For machines
purchased after 10/01/01)
505706 Shopsmith Gray (For machines
555752 Shopsmith Teal (For Scroll Saw)
Dri-Cote ® Sealants and Lubricants
$11.54 Each
Pocket Oiler
Fits in your pocket – and into close areas –
so you can oil anytime, anywhere!
D.
517429 Pocket Oiler
$39.13
Woodworking for Everyone
$3.74
Glide-Cote seals and protects
machine tabletops from rust
and corrosion. Low-friction, durable
coating repels dirt and moisture. No
fluorocarbon or silicone. Dries rapidly.
942204 Glide-Cote Sealant$15.11
10.75 ounces
Protect your valuable steel tools from rust with Silica Gel Packets
Dri-Cote® preserves tool surfaces
by sealing out moisture. Reduces
friction on cutting tools, protecting
them from corrosion and resin buildup. Great on table saw and bandsaw
blades, router and drill bits.
942203 Dri-Cote Lubricant $15.11
10.75 ounces
Dri-Cote Bearing Lubricant protects even the smallest bearings.
Ideal for rub collar and router bit
bearings. Lubricates and protects.
Environmentally safe.
942202 Dri-Cote Bearing $10.49
Lubricant
®
5256206Silica Gel Packets (Set of 6) $10.37
5.5 ounces
84
Shop Accessories
www.shopsmith.com
Sliding Bevel helps you measure
and duplicate angles
Great for
setting table,
radial arm or
circular saw
angles for
moldings
and more.
Also used for
measuring
angles (with
the aid of a protractor). A quick flip of the
brass lever locks the setting firmly.
Features an attractive handle with brass
at all wear points.
$17.59
518957 Sliding Bevel
Direct-reading Gauge takes the
guesswork out of measuring the
thickness of lumber or turnings
This
inexpensive
aluminum
gauge offers
the perfect
way to check
the thickness
of lumber you may be buying, workpieces you
may be planing, or bowls or similar projects
you may be turning on the lathe. Just slip the
curved jaws over the item to be measured and
read the thickness from 1/32˝ to 2˝
(0 to 55mm) on the dial.
$10.99
518991 Thickness Gauge
Affordable 6˝ Digital Dial Caliper measures in thousandths & millimeters
Here’s a fast-reading, digital caliper that’s
loaded with great features plus, represents
an outstanding value that’s tough to beat.
Made of rugged, hardened stainless steel, it will
measure inside dimensions, outside dimensions
and depths at a glance, and report to you in your
choice of thousandths or millimeters.
Features switchable inch/millimeter selection;
on/off switch; zeroing button; easy head locking
mechanism; and a replaceable battery.
NEW
556020 6˝ Dial Caliper
$22.99
Mite-R-Gauge measures and
transfers odd angles with
1/2° precision
Easily plot angles to within 1/2°
accuracy with this 6˝ Precision
Marking Protractor
The measuring
and setting of
precise angles
is extremely
important in
woodworking.
Triangles are
ideal for most
applications, but they will not do for many ˝odd˝
angles.
The Mite-R-Gauge Protractor/Bevel features
long legs with direct-reading protractor scales
that make easy work of this otherwise difficult
job and allows you to measure and read the
angle in a single step ... within 1/2 degree.
Once the angle is set, a quick twist of the
knob locks the gauge in position for transferring
to your table saw or other machine.
$21.99
730342 Mite-R-Gauge
Protractor/Bevel
This 21st
century Marking
Protractor has
micro-fine guide
holes at every
45°, 30° 22.5°,
5°, 1° and 0.5°
interval to plot any angle with ease and absolute
accuracy. A metal T-Bar and see-through
crosshairs provide exact alignment against the
edge of your workpiece. Remove the T-Bar
to work on flat surfaces. Contains four angle
scales: 0° left to 180° right, 180° left to 0°
right, 0° top to 90° left and right, and 90° top
to 0° left and right suits every need. It’s easy
on the eyes, incredibly accurate, and just plain
fun to use!
522172 6˝ Incra Precision
$31.39
Marking Protractor
(Calibrated to 1/2° & 1/32 ˝)
Revolutionary, zero-error Steel Rule
ensures that your measurements are
dead on-the-money – every time!
Drop a pencil point or
scribe through the Microfine hole or slot for your
measurement and mark
it. Precisely!
522174 6˝ Incra Precision T-Rule
Calibrated to 1/64 ˝
522173 12˝ Incra Precision T-Rule
Calibrated to 1/64 ˝
1-800-543-7586
$20.99
$36.69
Easy-to-use, versatile and
precise are the words that best
describe the Incra T-Rule. Microfine marking holes and slots at
every 1/16˝, 1/32˝ and 1/64˝
scale position instantly locate
your sharp pencil or scribe at
the exact measurement with
zero uncertainty and no eye
strain! This guarantees that the
precision built into the Incra
T-Rule actually shows up in your
finished work. Comes in 6˝ and
12˝ lengths.
Shop Accessories
85
Enjoy precision and accuracy with
an all-steel Square
Oriental Miter Square
It’s set at a 45° angle for a lifetime of precision
when measuring miters for picture frames,
cabinetmaking, and other applications. The wide
stainless steel marking edge can be flipped over
to scribe a line up to 41/2˝ long by marking from
both sides of your workpiece.
730486 Oriental Miter Square
$14.99
Made of superior grade steel, these
Squares are permanently set at a 90°
angle and remain unaffected by climatic changes. Available in a 6˝ length, they’re
perfect for machine setup, as well as hand
tool operations.
We recommend these all steel Squares for
those projects where precision is a must.
730343A 6˝ Engineer’s Square
$21.99
Steel Spring Calipers are a necessity
for accurate lathe and layout work
B
C
A
Center-Finding Rule takes the guesswork out of finding workpiece centers
This 18˝ flexible rule helps you determine the
center of triangular, rectangular, circular or any
odd shaped workpiece. No more fumbling with
tape measures or homemade center-finding
gadgets. Measuring 0˝ to 9˝ in both directions,
this tempered aluminum layout tool is graduated
in 16ths and 32nds of an inch.
730489 Center-Finding Rule
86
Shop Accessories
$10.99
With hardened fulcrum springs and tips, the
8˝ inside caliper and 6˝ outside caliper are just
the ticket for measuring spindle or faceplate
turnings on the lathe, dowels, hole diameters,
nut and bolt sizes and lots more.
The 6˝ divider features sharpened tips for
taking accurate measurements or scribing
circles or arcs from “0” to 61/2˝. The 6˝ outside
caliper measures from “0” to 61/4˝, while the
8˝ inside caliper measures from 7/8˝ to 91/4˝.
Available individually or in a set of three at
a very attractive savings.
A.
B.
C.
521929 6˝ Outside Caliper
521930 6˝ Divider
521931 8˝ Inside Caliper
$12.39
$12.39
$13.39
Buy all three and save!
521932 3-Pc. Caliper Package
Includes all three calipers above
$31.49
YOU SAVE $6.68
www.shopsmith.com
Miscellaneous
Shopsmith Accessories
Mobile Base brings portability
to machines and work tables
4-In-1 Razor Saw is perfect for
working on small projects
Table Height Adjustable Stop
Collars – for consistent accuracy
Use the Adjustable Stop Collar to set incremental
table height adjustments (1 turn = 1/16˝) for
Dado cuts, Tenons, Molding head cuts, finger
Joints, saw blade height and shaping.
You can also use them to set extension tables,
moving your fence in relation to the quill in the drill
press position, Special Purpose Tool alignments,
plus routing while using the Speed Increaser.
555937 Adjustable Stop Collar
$29.99
Cover protects your MARK V from
condensation and rust
Store machines and work tables out of the way
until needed ... then roll them out to go to work.
Base is adjustable in 1˝ increments from
a 12˝ x 12˝ square to a 36˝ square or a
20˝ x 52˝ rectangle. Four wheel design features
3˝ diameter locking wheels and adjustable
rubber leveling feet. Supports up to 400 pounds.
Made in the USA. Lifetime warranty.
$83.99
521718 Universal Mobile
Base
Flush-cut Saw won’t mar
workpiece surfaces
The comfortable wooden handle on this special
Razor Saw Set holds a nest of four interchangeable steel blades that can be attached and
removed with a single wing nut. Ideal for all
types of work where precision is important.
Includes the following four blades:
Back Saw
Back Saw
Keyhole
Push
Keyhole
Length
Depth
of Cut
T.P.I.
Thickness
1
5 /2˝
4 1/2˝
1 3/8˝
13
1 /16˝
13/32˝
2 1/4˝
32
52
24
.010˝
.008˝
.022˝
3/8˝
4 1/2˝
24
.022˝
521810 4-In-1 Razor Saw
This rugged, cotton/polyester cover is customsewn to the shape of your Shopsmith MARK V.
The special urethane coating repels moisture
while a unique perforation process allows
any moisture that might get in from below to
escape, preventing rust and corrosion.
$40.94
515306 MARK V Cover
Models 500, 505, 510 & 520
DC3300 Handle Retro-Fit Kit
For Dust Collectors made prior to May 2000
This inexpensive, simple-to-install kit lets you
attach an additional Handle to the top of the
3-Way Inlet on your DC3300 for convenience
when moving it around the shop.
The Kit includes the handle, two screws and
a template for marking pilot hole positions.
You’ll need a center punch, a 5/32˝ drill bit and
a Phillips screwdriver to do the job. Takes about
5 minutes.
$15.87
521769 DC3300 Handle
Retrofit Kit
1-800-543-7586
Use it to cut off dowels, tenons and similar
protrusions without fear of marring surfaces.
Super-thin, 6˝ long blade has 19 teeth-perinch with no set. 12˝ long overall.
521933 Japanese Flush-Cut
$13.59
Radis-Plane softens edges
$13.99
Saw
Rawhide Mallet won’t damage lathe
centers or chisel handles
Avoid damaging your tools and your projects.
The tough, non-marring rawhide head is 4˝ long
x 2˝ diameter. Perfect for setting Lathe Drive
Centers and a host of other jobs.
730271 Rawhide Mallet
✍
$27.59
After retiring, I began thinking of
woodworking as a hobby. I purchased
a MARK V and have since added a
Bandsaw, Jointer, Planer, Jig Saw and a Scroll
Saw. With these tools, I have made many
woodcraft projects for my grandchildren.
~ Walter Menner, Millstadt, IL
This clever little plane is the perfect choice
for rounding over sharp project edges for
reasons of safety, appearance or, in the case
of cabinet doors, for a better, more professional
looking fit. The radius can be adjusted from
1/16˝ to 1/4˝ on any edge. The first of two
cutters makes the initial cut, while the second
cleans a perfect radius.
Includes the Radius Blade Set (a Straight
Blade Set is available for creating chamfered
edges). Maple body with a brass soleplate.
735000 Radis-Plane with
$26.19
Radius Blade
735050 Replacement Radius
$8.39
Blade Set
735051 Straight Blade Set
For chamfering
Shop Accessories
$8.39
87
Router Dovetail Fixture makes perfect half-blind
dovetails and box joints
Just mount your router to
the special base, clamp your
mating workpieces into the
guide comb and go to work.
Makes 1/2˝ half-blind dovetails
and splicing dovetails (joining
two boards end-to-end), as
well as 3/8˝ box joints. Will not
cut through dovetails. Includes
step-by-step instructions for
use. Bits ordered
separately below.
720428 Router Dovetail Fixture
Made in Germany.
521873 1/2˝ Dovetail Router Bit
$62.99
$10.49
521874 3/8˝ Straight Router Box Joint Bit
Spring-loaded Chisel squares routed
corners for hinge mortises and more
$10.49
Horsehair Bench
Brush removes sawdust and chips
Handy Gauge helps you set router bit
depths accurately
Horsehair Bench Brush has been the choice
of woodworkers and other craftsmen for
generations. 13˝ long with 21/8˝ long genuine
Horsehair bristles.
A dado or groove that’s too deep can jeopardize
the strength and ruin the appearance of a joint.
This handy gauge eliminates these problems
by providing accurate settings in an instant.
Just rest the gauge’s feet on your router’s
base or your router table insert and move the
appropriate notch over the tip of your bit to
make your setting. Graduated in 1/16˝ increments from 1/8˝ to 1˝. Can also be used to
set saw blade depths up to 1˝.
Just drop the self-aligning
chisel into the rounded corner
of any mortise or recess made
by a router bit (such as the
rabbet in the back of a picture
frame) and strike it with a
hammer to transform the
mortise into a perfect 90°
corner in a single whack. No measuring.
No mistakes.
518982 Router Corner Chisel
$16.59
Multipurpose Saw Aid ® works seven
ways to improve your safety and
precision as a ...
753118 Horsehair Bench Brush
$13.69
521939 Router Bit Depth Gauge
Rout or sand without clamping using
the Router Master Mat
Safety Push Stick... with a comfortable handle
to keep you out of harm’s way.
Angle Gauge... that measures and marks 30°,
45°, 60° and 90° angles.
6˝ Hook Rule... measures lengths from edges.
9˝ Rule... for taking quick measurements.
Center-Finder... for marking centers of dowels
and lathe spindles.
90° Square... for checking joints or machine
set-ups.
$16.54
521845 Saw Aid
88
Shop Accessories
This 24˝ x 36˝ mat holds your workpiece in
position without sliding or moving as you rout.
Rolls up for storage.
712001 Router Master Mat
$10.99
$8.39
Minwax ® Paste Finishing Wax coats
and protects your power tool surfaces
Just apply a thin coat of
the premium-quality wax
to the exposed metal
surfaces of your MARK V
or Special Purpose Tools
to protect against rust
and corrosion.
It provides and easyglide, virtually frictionfree surface for work tables, rip fences and
similar work-guiding surfaces. 16 oz. can.
522454 Minwax ® Paste Wax
$9.99
www.shopsmith.com
Project Plans / Hands-On CD’s
Order individually, or purchase them by the set and SAVE!
NEW
522095 Hands-On CD
Vol. 7
$14.95*
9-Drawer Woodshop Toolbox, Child’s
Desk and Chairs, Candle Sconce and
Desktop Pencil Holder.
522422 Hands-On CD
Vol. 16
$14.95*
Knock-Down/Store-Away Table, Home
Shop Workbench, Rolling Pin and
Dried Flower Vase.
522488 Hands-On CD
Vol. 25
$14.95*
A Gift For Your Kitchen, Outdoor Deck
Chair and Bandsaw Boxes.
522494 Hands-On CD
Vol. 31
$14.95*
Adjustable Shelf Bookcase, Nesting Tables,
Lantern Holder and Toy Top.
522096 Hands-On CD
Vol. 8
$14.95*
Garden Bench, Wren and Bluebird
Birdhouse, and a Tapered Planter Box.
522423 Hands-On CD
Vol. 17
$14.95*
Queen Anne Living Room Tables,
Covered Wagon Toy Box and Tilting
Shelf Sewing Thread Holder.
522489 Hands-On CD
Vol. 26
$14.95*
Sheltered Swing, Turn-Of-The-Century
Medicine Cabinet and Puzzle Power.
522495 Hands-On CD
Vol. 32
$14.95*
Porch Railings & Spindles, Heart-Shaped
Three Tier Stand and Oval Picture Frame
with Router Arm.
522424 Hands-On CD
Vol. 18
$14.95*
California Dream Toys, Mantel Clock
and Christmas Tree Ornaments.
522490 Hands-On CD
Vol. 27
$14.95*
English Flip-Top Chair/Table, Oval
Magazine Rack and Laminated Wooden
Domino Set.
522182 Hands-On CD
Vol. 10
$14.95*
Four Poster Bed, Sunshade Sandbox,
and Paper Towel Holder with Secret
Compartment.
522425 Hands-On CD
Vol. 19
$14.95*
Designing, Remodeling & Creating
a New Kitchen Pt. 1, Wooden Utensil
Rack & Knife Block/Cutting Board, and
Gallery Rail Paper-Towel Holder.
522491 Hands-On CD
Vol. 28
$14.95*
Heirloom Cradle, Spirit of St. Louis
Airplane and All-Purpose Wooden Boxes.
522183 Hands-On CD
Vol. 11
$14.95*
Toy Train, Toy Puzzles, Cold Plant
Frame and Kitchen Helpers.
522426 Hands-On CD
$14.95*
Vol. 20
Strip Laminate Bending, Turned Hall
Tree and Two Great Kitchen Gift Items.
522418 Hands-On CD
Vol. 12
$14.95*
Pembroke Table, Cheval Mirror,
Child’s Sled and Climbing Bear.
522427 Hands-On CD
Vol. 21
$14.95*
Hanging Glass Door Cabinets, Outdoor
Duckboards and Adjustable Plant Shelf.
522419 Hands-On CD
Vol. 13
$14.95*
Classic Rolltop Desk - Pt. 1, 16-Drawer
Apothecary Chest and Letter Box.
522428 Hands-On CD
Vol. 22
$14.95*
Antique Quilt Display Rack, HeartShaped Display Stand and Duck Napkin
Holder.
522093 Hands-On CD
Vol. 5
$14.95*
Dry Sink, Hanging Wall Clock,
and Child’s Pounding Bench
and Wooden Top.
522420 Hands-On CD
Vol. 14
$14.95*
Classic Rolltop Desk - Pt. 2, Keyed
Corner Jewelry Box and Colonial
Spice Cabinet.
522429 Hands-On CD
Vol. 23
$14.95*
Living Room Sofa Table, Hob Hill Cable
Car and Two Shelf Telephone Stand/
Side Table.
522094 Hands-On CD
Vol. 6
$14.95*
Classic Rocking Horse, Child’s
Chalkboard, Wine Rack and
Desktop Bookshelf.
522421 Hands-On CD
Vol. 15
$14.95*
Wall-Hung Curio Cabinet, Mobile
Potting Table and Pencil/Stamp Holder.
522089 Hands-On CD
Vol. 1
$31.99
Three part series on the Grandfather
Clock Project, plus six other projects:
Gumball Machine, Dancing Duck Puppet, Toy Crane, Chess Set, Porch Swing,
and the Kite String Winder.
522090 Hands-On CD
Vol. 2
$14.95*
Roll-around Barbeque Cart, Patio/
Deck Table, & the Pecking Chickens.
522091 Hands-On CD
Vol. 3
$14.95*
Curio Cabinet, Pot-Holding Garden
Planter, and Kitchen Pasta Tools.
522092 Hands-On CD
Vol. 4
$14.95*
Butcher Block/Microwave Oven Table,
Gourmet Bird Feeder, and Interlocking
Play Logs.
522181 Hands-On CD
Vol. 9
$14.95*
Tall Bookshelf, Folding Party
Trays, Mug Holder, Shelf, Baseball
Equipment Holder.
522496 Hands-On CD
Vol. 33
$14.95*
Entrance To Your Home, Rotating BenchTop Storage Unit and Kite String Winder.
522497 Hands-On CD
Vol. 34
$14.95*
Gateleg Table Plan, All-American Picnic
Table and Slanted Gourmet Knife Block.
555917 Hands On! $108.25
522492 Hands-On CD
CD-ROM
Vol. 29
$14.95*
Package
9-Drawer Tabletop Storage Chest, Flying
Hands-On CD Volumes 2 thru 11,
Tiger Toy Airplane, Vertical Paper Towel
44 Projects in all – valued at $141.89
Holder and Bread-Shaped Cutting &
Receive Volume 1 FREE.
Cheese Boards.
522493 Hands-On CD
Vol. 30
$14.95*
Pendulum Cradle, Candle Stand, PullAlong Dog and Salt & Pepper Shakers.
555996 Hands-On $108.25
CD-ROM
Package
Hands-On CD Volumes 12 thru 24.
39 Projects in all. Valued at $142.87
Our most popular woodworking projects ALL on one CD
522465 20 Great
522468 12 Outdoor
Gift Projects
Projects
$19.95
From Volumes 6, 11, and 18.
Includes easy-to-follow instructions
522430 Hands-On CD
for 20 of our most popular projects,
Vol. 24
$14.95*
from toys ... to furniture ... to kitchen
Poor Man’s Hall Butler, Holiday
accessories ... to craft projects, and
Hurricane Lamp and Old-Fashioned
much more.
Toy Cars.
*Prices include shipping and handling.
$19.95
From Volumes 2, 8, and 21.
Includes easy-to-follow instructions
for 12 of our most popular outdoor
projects, from furniture ... to bird
houses ... to cabinets and planters, and
much more.
America’s favorite woodworking project plans ... for your MARK V!
Ideal for Shopsmith woodworkers of all skill levels. Many of
these plans were originally designed and built on a Shopsmith
MARK V. The unique “trace, saw and assemble” designs feature
Easy
Rocking
Horse
Child’s
Beautiful 45˝
Glider
high prancer
rocking horse
will become a treasured heirloom.
Detail plans include material list,
full-size templates, exploded views,
and helpful hints. A miniature
version 18˝ high is also available.
803123 Rocking Horse
(Standard)
522164 Rocking Horse
(Miniature)
$10.99
Swing pivots
provide a
motion similar
to that of a
curved rocker, yet works great on
carpeted floors (Ages 2 through 7).
516354 Easy Child’s
Glider
$10.99
$10.99
Cedar Chest
Planter 201/2˝
square x 17˝ high. Bench is 36˝
long x 15˝ wide x 17˝ high.
A handsome
and sturdy
chest. Calls for
cedar, but pine
and oak work well. 20˝ tall x 48˝
long x 20˝ deep.
521693 Planter/Bench
521754 Cedar Chest
Planter/
Bench
$10.99
1-800-543-7586
$10.99
simple-to-follow instructions that allow beginners to achieve professional results. Plans include patterns, material list, assembly
illustrations and photos.
Wishing
Playhouse
Lighthouse
Perfect hideBuilt from a
Well
Dress up your
front yard
with this 4˝
dia. Wishing
Well. 7˝ tall, featuring an authentic bucket with a working windlass and crank-style handle.
521691 Wishing Well
$10.99
single piece
of 4˝ x 8˝ plywood. 5˝ tall,
this handsome
project can be
fitted with a
solar-powered
garden path light on top.
521700 Lighthouse
Birdhouse
Assortment
7 plans include
4 houses &
3 feeders.
Traceable
pieces.
521748 Birdhouse
Assortment
$18.79
521698 Playhouse
$10.99
$10.99
Canopy
Glider
Swing
An 8˝ long x
61/2˝ wide x 8˝
high twin glider.
521695 Canopy Glider
Swing
away for
children. Full
sized patterns.
Measures 6˝
square, including porch x 6˝ tall.
$10.99
Pet Bed
A fun, family
weekend
project for
devoted pet
owners. Two full pattern sizes
included: 22˝w x 12˝h x 131/2˝d
30˝w x 14˝h x 171/2˝d.
522254 Pet Bed
Project Plans
$11.99
89
Shopsmith’s exciting, new
Personalized Owner’s Home Page
www.shopsmith.net
Create your Personalized
Home Page that you can
access with a simple
mouse click!
Here’s what’s available at the Shopsmith Page right now:
Standard page components to get you off to a
great start
• A Shopsmith icon that gives you immediate access to your Home Page
with a click of your mouse.
• An opportunity to access Shopsmith’s current email specials in their
own area of your Home Page.
• A Super Home Page Specials area where only Personalized users
qualify for big savings.
• Personalized tools and suggestions on how to make your Home Page
your own.
Optional page components you can add where you want
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
FREE Woodworking Project Plans.
Access to Shopsmith’s FREE Woodworking Tip Of The Day.
A direct link to Shopsmith’s online HANDS-ON Magazine.
An instant-access Search Box to everything on Shopsmith’s website.
Access to view and/or download PDF copies of Shopsmith Manuals.
Quick Access Tech Center featuring maintenance and operating tips.
Access to Shopsmith’s exciting new Woodworking Forum.
Direct access to information about the status of your outstanding
Shopsmith orders.
www.shopsmith.net/forums
Ask questions and read
comments from fellow
Shopsmith woodworkers!
• A forum for ALL woodworkers (not just Shopsmith tool owners).
• Share woodworking tips and ideas with others having similar interests.
• Get the answers to your general woodworking questions.
You asked for it – it’s arrived
and it’s FREE!
Sign up NOW! First come – First served!
Don’t lose the user name and password
you want to someone else.
• Benefit from the collective experience of thousands of woodworkers.
• Make new friends and learn new techniques.
Visit www.shopsmith.net & www.shopsmith.net/forums
now and start building your own Personalized Owner’s Home Page today!
90
Home Page/Forum
www.shopsmith.com
1-800-543-7586
91
There’s a lot in store for you at:
www.shopsmith.com
The Shopsmith website is jam-packed with valuable information for owners of Shopsmith
tools and equipment ...as well as anyone with an interest in setting up a MARK V-based
home workshop. Split into five basic areas of information,you’ll be able to quickly access:
•
•
•
•
•
More information about the remarkable Shopsmith MARK V .
Loads of great woodworking project plans and ideas.
Hundreds of valuable,work-saving woodworking tips and techniques.
The answers you seek to your important woodworking questions.
A gargantuan amount of valuable information that will help you become a better
woodworker – or learn more about the remarkable Shopsmith MARK V and our full
range of Shopsmith Accessories.
It’s all waiting for you at: www.shopsmith.com
1.
2.
Shopsmith MARK V Information – Get
all the MARK V information you need online
or by mail. View our online schedule of live
MARK V demonstrations (perhaps in your
area). Learn about the woodworking hobby.
Visit HANDS-ON, our online woodworking
webzine. Get help planning your workshop.
Visit the Shopsmith Woodworking Forum
for the answers to your woodworking
questions; sign up for FREE weekly
woodworking tips; download copies of
selected Owner’s Manuals, get FREE project
plans and lots, lots more!
3.
Accessory & Parts Catalogs – Visit our
online Shopsmith Accessory Catalog or ask
for a mailed copy. Go to our Quick Order
Form, purchase a Shopsmith Gift Card.
4.
Current Offers & Promotions – View the
money-saving offers that are available to
you right now. Order Shopsmith Tool repair
parts, request a repair parts catalog, read
our service bulletins, find out where to
have your Shopsmith Tools serviced and
pick up valuable service tips.
5.
About Shopsmith – Read all about the
history of Shopsmith, contact Customer
Services, view our FAQ's, access
important policies, employment data and
contact information.
The Shopsmith website exists for your benefit
and enjoyment. We hope you enjoy its content
and invite you to visit often.
The Shopsmith National Woodworking Academy presents
Below: The Cast & Crew of
Shopsmith Sawdust Sessions
Woodworking Information for the 21-st Century
Watch tool demonstrations, explore new techniques, build amazing projects, collect professional
tips and secrets, even get your personal woodworking questions answered right online! All you
need is a computer and a connection to the Internet. From its webshop in Dayton, Ohio, the
Shopsmith National Woodworking Academy webcasts:
Video Archive – We record our Video Tips and Sawdust Sessions, and then archive them on
our web site where you can watch them anytime you want FREE!
The Shopsmith Channel – We webcast a woodworking channel over the Internet from
www.youtube.com/shopsmithhandsonline, where we have posted our most popular short
videos. These, too, are positively 100% FREE!
VBooks – We build unique educational adventures around our videos, combining them with
photos, illustrations, text, and plans. VBooks are just as easy to use as DVDs but offer so much
more, letting you delve into a woodworking topic as deeply as you like.
www.shopsmithacademy.com
A good craftsman needs good tools and the know-how to use them.
Only Shopsmith gives you both.
92
Online Academy
www.shopsmith.com
New from the Shopsmith National Woodworking Academy
HANDS ONLINE! VBOOKS™ combine the excitement of live demonstration,
the in-depth information of books, the visual power of video, and the experience of
master craftsmen with the convenience of modern media.
Shopsmith is proud to present a whole new way of learning about woodwoodworking.
It’s called a VBook (vee-book) and it combines the best of traditional and cutting-edge
communication technologies.
A VBook comes on a DVD disc, but it’s
so much more than a video. It can be
viewed on computers (with DVD drives),
mp4 players, and most DVR players.
At the heart of each VBook is a unique
method of presentation called a
Virtual Classroom (shown right).
It combines videos, photos, illustrations,
text, and Internet resources on a single
screen. You can watch and listen to a
demo on a woodworking topic, study
close-ups and diagrams, read
professional tips and secrets, and print
out shop notes and plans. All of this
in the convenience of your
own home OR take it with
you as a podcast!
How it works:
Each VBook disc contains
HTML files with embedded
videos, images, and text.
You navigate from
classroom to classroom
and within the classrooms
in your browser. No new
computer programs
needed; no new computer
skills to learn.
The Screen
The Blackboard
• Plays MP4 video flles of woodworking
demonstrations.
• 6 to 8 videos (about 2 hours) per disc.
• Uses Quicktime™ for maximum
compatibility with all browsers.
• Enlarge and reduce the sizes of the
videos easily.
• Use the video index to quickly flnd and
play speciflc scenes in a video.
• Download the videos to a portable
MP4 player (or any device that runs
mp4/acc flles) and take them with you.
• Displays relevant photos and illustrations
on command.
• Enlarge these images with a click of
your mouse.
• Discover more information embedded
in an image by moving the cursor over
it to reveal hidden tags.
• Access plans, articles, lists of resources,
and helpful programs with a mouse click.
• Print images, plans, and articles – or
download to your MP4 player*.
The Notebook
• Displays the “Shop Notes” of the presenter
to make it easy to follow the demonstration.
• Contains links to tools, resources, and
additional information available on the
Internet.
• Print a version of the notes that also
includes the images from the Blackboard
to take to your workshop or keep for
reference.
• Download these notes to your MP4
player* to read whenever you want.
*To take advantage of these features, your MP4 player must be able to display .pdf files and common image files such as jpegs and gifs.
Enjoy woodworking anywhere, anytime with Shopsmith’s
HANDS ONLINE! VBOOKS™ on DVD discs.
Combines the educational and entertainment benefits of video, photography, illustration, and
text. Pop them in your computer or download them to your portable MP4 player.
522537 Sawdust Session 1, Mortising, alignment, conical sander, drill press
$14.95*
Participate in a LIVE Sawdust Session
at www.shopsmithacademy.com!
1-800-543-7586
National Academy
93
Product Index
Abrasive Cleaning Stick ..... 16, 20, 72
Accessory Shelf .............................27
Anti-Fatigue Mat ............................14
Aprons ................................... 40, 83
Arbors ......................... 34-35, 67, 75
Auxiliary Fence Package.................18
Bandsaw, 11˝ ..................................8
Bandsaw Blades ............................10
Bandsaw Cool Blocks .......................9
Bandsaw Eccentric Tubes ................9
Bandsaw Extension Table .................9
Bandsaw Fence ...............................9
Bandsaw Rip Fence, Kreg ..............11
Bandsaw Table Extension .................9
Bandsaw Tire/Adhesive Kits..............9
Bandsaw Tires, Urethane ................9
Bandsaw Upgrades ........................11
Retro-Fit Dust Chute ..................11
Retro-Fit Kits .............................11
Table System ............................11
Belt Sander, 6˝ ..............................15
Belt Sander Retro-Kit .....................16
Belt Sander Router Chuck, 1/4˝ ......16
Belt Sander Sanding Belts ..............16
Bench Brush, Horsehair .................85
Bevel, Sliding.................................85
Biscuit Joiner/Biscuits ....................44
Calipers.................................. 78, 85
Casters, Retractable................ 13, 30
Center-Finding Rule .......................86
Chisel Sharpening Attachment . 20, 40
Clamps.................................... 82-83
Conical Disc Sanding Kit ................73
Conical Sandpaper Discs/Sleeves ...73
Connector Tubes, 5-Foot................30
Countersink Set .............................74
Crosscut Sliding Table....................37
Dado Set, Carbide-Tipped ..............35
Dial Caliper, 6˝ ...............................85
Dial Set-Up Gauge .........................31
Disc Sander Dust Chute .......... 25, 71
DriCote®, Sealants & Lubricants.... 84
Drill Bits ........................................74
Drill Chuck & Key ...........................75
Drill Press Handle ..........................75
Drum Sanding, 6˝ .........................72
Drum Sanding Pkgs. & Accy. ..........72
Dust Collector ................................23
Dust Collector Accessory Kits .........25
Dust Collector Dust Chute ..............25
Dust Collector Filter Hoods .............23
Dust Collector Flange Ferrule..........24
Dust Collector Handle
Retro-fit Kit ............................. 25, 87
Dust Collector Hoses/Fittings/Bags....24
Dust Collector Wireless
On/Off Switch ................................24
Dust Collector Foot On/Off Switch ....24
Dust Collector Upgrades .................25
94
Retro-Fit Kits .............................25
Saw Guard/Systems...................25
Dust Collector Utility Vacuum
Extension.......................................24
Dust Covers
Bandsaw .....................................9
Belt Sander ...............................16
Jointer ......................................18
MARK V ............................. 75, 87
Planer .......................................22
Scroll Saw .................................13
Strip Sander ..............................20
Dust Respirator ....................... 16, 29
Dustpan ........................................88
Engineer’s Square, 6˝.....................86
Extension Tables/Kits .....................30
Face Shield, Ratchet ......................29
Featherboard, Rip Fence-Mount......29
Fence Stop, Flip-Up .......................76
Fence System/Pro ..........................46
Foot Switches ......................... 14, 24
Forstner Bits ..................................75
Grinding Guard & Wheels ...............39
Hand Scraper ................................73
Hands-On CDs (Vol. 1-34)...............89
Hearing Protectors .................. 22, 29
Help Kit, 60 Piece ..........................84
Honing Guide .................................39
INCRA Fence/Router System/Pkg ...41
INCRA Miter Express .....................99
INCRA Miter Gauge 2000 ..............42
Pre-Drilled Floating Tables ..........41
Right Angle Fixture ....................41
Shaper Attachment ....................41
Shop Stop Positioner..................41
Wonder Fence Router/Shaper
Attachment ...............................41
INCRA MiterSled 5000...................42
INCRA Precision Protractor...... 31, 85
INCRA Precision T-Rule .................85
INCRA TSIII Ultra Fence Table ........41
Inserts, Table........ 35, 67, 69, 71, 72
Jointer, 4˝......................................17
Jointer Auxiliary Fence/Kit ..............18
Jointer Replacement Knives............18
Jointer/Planer Knife Sharpener .......18
Jointer Upgrades ...........................18
Dust Chute Retro-fit Kit ..............18
Featherguards Retro-fit
Installation Kits ..........................18
Lathe Center Finder .......................78
Lathe Chisel Set Packages ...... 78, 79
Lathe Chisels & Accessories ...........78
Lathe Chuck Systems ....................81
Lathe Cutter Profiles ......................77
Lathe Duplicator ............................77
Lathe Duplicator Steady Rest ..........77
Lathe Jumbo Jaws.........................81
Lathe See-Through Shield ....... 29, 77
Lathe Tool Rests/Package ........ 79-80
Product Index
Lathe Turning Package ..................78
Lathe Upgrade Kits ........................80
Mallet, Rawhide .............................87
MARK V Extension Table Brackets ....37
MARK V Lift-Assist .........................28
MARK V Speed Chart .....................31
MARK V Upgrades ....................... 4-7
Extension Tables..........................6
Pro Fence & Table Systems ..... 4-6
Rip Fence ....................................6
Rip Scale.....................................7
Saw Guards/Systems ...................6
Table System Retro-fit Kit.............5
Two-Bearing Quill ........................6
Mite-R-Gauge Protractor/Bevel . 31, 85
Miter Gauge Extension, 20˝ ..............36
Miter Gauge Pkg./Accessories ........36
Miter Gauge Safety Grip .......... 29, 36
Miter Square .................................86
Miter-Pro™.....................................36
Mobile Base, Universal ...................87
Molding Knives ..............................68
Molding Package ...........................67
Mortising Package .........................43
Mounting Base, Aluminum .............27
Oiler, Pocket ..................................84
Oscillating Drum Sander.................70
Overarm Pin Router .......................48
Paint, Touch-Up .............................84
Pantograph............................. 86, 88
Paste Wax, Minwax® ......................88
Planer Dust Chute..........................22
Planer/Jointer Knife Sharpener .......38
Planer Replacement Knives ............22
Planer Upgrades ............................22
Knurled Infeed Roller..................22
Pulley Retro-Kit..........................22
Retro Attachment.......................22
Planer, MARK V Mount...................21
Planer, Pro ...................................21
Plug Cutter Set, Tapered ................76
Pounce Wheel Set .........................86
Power Coupler/Kits ........................26
Power Stands ................................26
Power Station ................................26
Power Station Cover.......................26
Power Tool Woodworking
for Everyone Book ..........................84
Project Plans .................................89
Radi Plane .....................................87
Razor Saw, 4-in-1 .........................87
Ring Master ...................................98
Roller Stand............................ 30, 37
Router Accessories ........................48
Router Bit Depth Gauge........... 31, 85
Router Bits ............................. 44, 47
Router Chuck & Shield ...................44
Router Corner Chisel ......................88
Router Dovetail Fixture ...................88
Router Package .............................44
Router Table Featherboard .............29
Router Table Kit .............................47
Safety Goggles ..............................29
Safety Kit.......................................29
Sanding Discs, Steel 12˝ ................71
Sanding Discs/Accessories .............71
Saw Aid.........................................88
Saw Blade Cleaner.........................35
Saw Blades & Packages .................34
Saw, Flush-Cut ..............................87
Scroll Saw, 20˝ ..............................12
Scroll Saw Blades ..........................14
Scroll Saw Casters, Free-Standing ..14
Scroll Saw Foot Switch, Unguarded...14
Scroll Saw Upgrades ......................13
Saw Blade Block........................13
Saw Blade Change System Kit....13
Self-Study Course ..........................84
Service Parts Price List ............ 50-66
Shaper Cutters ..............................70
Shaper/Router Upgrades ......... 45, 47
Adjustable Fence & Hardware.....47
Retro-Fit Kit ...............................45
Shaper/Drum Sander Vacuum
Attachment ........................ 45, 72
Shaping Package ...........................69
Sharpening Gauge .........................38
Sharpening Guides & Packages ......38
Sharpening Stones & Oil ................39
Slot Mortising Package...................45
Speed Increaser.............................32
Speed Increaser Fence...................32
Speed Increaser Router
Bit Adapter, 1/4˝ ............................32
Speed Increaser Shaper Spindles....32
Speed Reducer ..............................33
Step Gauge, Aluminum ..................31
Stop Collar, Adjustable ...................87
Storage Cabinets ...........................27
Storage Station ..............................27
Storage Station, Wall-Mounted .......27
Straightedge, 4-foot .......................85
Strip Sander ..................................19
Strip Sander Chisel Sharpening
Attachment....................................20
Strip Sander Magnifier Lamp ..........20
Strip Sander Sanding Belts .............20
Strip Sander Utility Light .................20
Support Tables ..............................37
Table Support Leg .........................30
Tenon Master™ Jig .........................45
Thickness Gauge ...........................85
Toggle Clamp Assembly .................45
Tool Bar, Magnetic.........................83
Triangle Set, Aluminum ........... 31, 85
Utility Light ............................. 20, 76
Vise, Bench/Drill Press ...................76
Wood Finishings ............................80
Wrench, Arbor ...............................34
Yardstick, Compass Points .............86
www.shopsmith.com
The amazing new SAND-FLEE®designed for Shopsmith
is an unparalleled surface finishing wizard
To install the abrasives, cut your strips to the specified length using the
patterns we provide and rotate the drum by hand to wind the 3˝ wide
abrasive onto the Drum. Install strips of two or three different grits if you
like – for multiple - step super-smooth sanding without stopping work for
grit changes.
Besides its obvious advantage of sanding the surfaces of stock up to
36˝ wide. It’s also perfect for specialized operations such as:
Joining the edges of stock.
Sanding the protruding components of joinery (such as mortise-andtenon, dovetails or box joints) flush with surfaces.
Safely finish-sanding the surfaces of resawn boards of super-thin
veneers – or ends of long or tall standing workpieces – without fear
of them being grabbed or thrown.
®
The SAND-FLEE attaches to your machine just like all our other Special
Purpose Tools, giving you a variable speed sander that promises to save you
hours of tedious hand sanding.
You’ll use it to remove that final whisker off the edges, ends or surfaces of
wood, composite – even metal projects without fear of burning, sniping or
injury. And when you’ve finished, you’ll have a surface that’s far smoother
than anything you could hope to attain by hand or with the aid of another
machine – in anywhere near the smae amount of time.
Its 23˝ x 21-1/4˝ stainless steel top supports your stock as you advance it
across the rotating, 18˝ long, aluminum Drum, positioned hust beneath it
surface. The Drum and the abrasive rool used on it are both covered with
hook-&-loop material to facilitate quick, easy grit changes – then the table
height is adjusted so that only the abrasive grit is proud of the table surface.
Although it has a 2-1/2˝ dust collection port, it captures 85% of its own dust
inside the cabinet – so you’ll seldom need to hook it up.
556042 Shopsmith SAND-FLEE®
$599.99
Finishing Drum Sander
(Manual included)
Guide Sanding Fence helps you guide workpieces across the
rotating Drum. 24-3/8˝ long w/ three T-slots, plus hardware and
threaded knobs for attaching to the slots in the SAND-FLEE® Table.
556043 Optional SAND-FLEE® Fence
$79.99
Hobby-Pack Abrasive Roll Package, Inlcudes six, 3˝ x 10-meter
rolls of hook-and-loop abrasives–one each, 100, 120, 150, 180,
220 and 320-grit. (Approx. 8 full-width wraps per roll)
$107.95
556044 Hobby-Pack Abrasive Roll Pkg
Individual Abrasive Rolls 3˝ x 10-meter rolls $19.95 each
556045 100-Grit
556048 180-Grit
556046 120-Grit
556049 220-Grit
556047 150-Grit
556050 320-Grit
Get added precision and control with the Kreg Deluxe Bandsaw Rip Fence
Deluxe Fence increases your Bandsaw’s ripping capacity and cutting versatility
Optional 4 ½˝ high Resawing
Guide attaches to the T-Slot in the
Rib Fence face. Its gently curved
face allows you to follow a drawn
line down the top edge of a board
to be resawed ... compensating
for blade lead as you go. The
Pros say, these are the best style
Resawing Fences!
This Fence System was designed exclusively for the Shopsmith Bandsaw.
The rugged aluminum rail extrusions attach to the existing holes in theunderside of late model Shopsmith Bandsaws with self-tapping bolts (included).
Once attached, you’ll have a 20˝ long by 2 3/4˝ high precision rip fence with
a direct-reading scale that locks firmly into position with a single knob to
rip stock up to 9 3/8˝ wide (that’s 4 3/8˝ wider than our regular Bandsaw
Fence). Its face and top surfaces both include preformed T-slots to accepts
Shopsmith’s Flip Stops, Featherboards, and Utility Lights – or your choice of
special shop-made jigs and fixtures.
This Fence can also be laid down and attached to the mounting head
horizontally. The Fence fac can also be used with your Premium bandsaw
Fence on the MARK V or other Shopsmith tools.
Note: Not for older model Bandsaws with cast iron worktables.
1-800-543-7586
Optional Micro-Adjuster
clamps into the Fence Rail
T-Slot with a large comfortable knob. Then, simply
loosen the Fence Mounting
Head and rotate the MicroAdjuster’s thumbwheel to
gradually advance or retrieve
the Fence by 1/20˝ with
each full rotation.
522460 Mounting Rail & Hardware
556032 Front & Rear Fence Supports
556005 20˝ Premium Bandsaw Fence
556030 Complete Bandsaw Rip Fence System
$89.00
$39.00
$59.95
$174.99
(Includes Mounting Rail & Hardware,Front & Rear
Fence Supports and Premium Bandsaw Fence)
522511 Bandsaw Fence Micro-Adjuster
522514 Bandsaw Fence Resawing Guide
556031 Deluxe Bandsaw Fence System
$15.99
$18.99
$209.97
(Includes Complete Bandsaw Rip Fence System,Micro-Adjuster & Resawing Guide)
New Products
95
Look for these symbols to find the best application
for your Shopsmith accessories
If one of the following symbols appears next to an accessory in this catalog, it cannot be used
on that equipment model.
Four Easy Ways to Order
1. By Phone …
Just call our factory-direct line, TOLL-FREE:
1-800-543-7586
Will NOT Fit With:
10ER
MARK II MARK V MARK V
VII
500
MARK V MARK V
505
510
MARK V
520
NOTE: Be sure to order accessories for your particular Model MARK V (500, 505, 510 or 520).
If you have upgraded your Model 500 with a Table System Retro-fit Kit, order Model 510 accessories. If you have questions about the model you own, call our Service/Technical Support department at 1-800-762-7555. The Shopsmith MARK VII, MARK II, and 10 ER were products of Magna
American Corp.
GOLD MEDAL BUYER PROTECTION PLAN
ASSURES COMPLETE SATISFACTION
1. 30-Day Money-Back Guarantee – Buyer must be satisfied or we’ll refund the purchase price.
2. TWO Years Full Warranty – Covers all parts and labor for two years from date of purchase.
3. Exclusive Loaner Headstock Program – If Headstock ever needs repair, customer receives a
loaner Headstock to use while repairs are made.
2. By Mail …
Complete the order form and mail to:
ATTN: Order Dept.
Shopsmith, Inc.
6530 Poe Avenue
Dayton, OH 45414-2591
3. By FAX …
24 hours/7 days, FAX the completed form
TOLL-FREE:
1-800-722-3965
4. Online …
Just log onto and place your order over the
Internet. You can browse the products by
name, or search for them by part number.
www.shopsmith.com
4. Lifetime Reconditioning Program – Shopsmith will recondition a MARK V to like-new condition
at any time for a fraction of its replacement cost.
5. Limited Lifetime Warranty – Protects the Shopsmith MARK V against defects in manufacturing
and workmanship.
6. FREE Service Hotline – We’re always standing by to help you. To get fast solutions to your
problems, simply give us a call TOLL-FREE at 1-800-762-7555.
Lifetime Reconditioning Program
The MARK V’s, Planer, Bandsaw, Jointer, Belt Sander, Scroll Saw and
Strip Sander are rugged pieces of equipment. But constant use over
years may lead to a need for reconditioning. At any time, give us a call
and we’ll tell you how to take advantage of this program. We’ll rebuild
any of the above Shopsmith, Inc. manufactured equipment and replace
wearing parts, including the motor. Your cost will not exceed one-third
of the current list price of the equipment at the time of the repair. A quotation will be provided
prior to any work.
Other Mailing Lists
Email Specials
We occasionally make our customer list
available to carefully screened companies
and organizations whose products and/or
services we feel may be of interest to you*.
By supplying Shopsmith with your email
address, you will be notified of email only
specials throughout the year.
If you would prefer not to receive such mail,
please copy your mailing address and mail it to:
Attn: Mail Preference Service
Shopsmith, Inc.
6530 Poe Avenue
Dayton, OH 45414-2591
*We will never release your phone number to anyone!
96
Ordering Information
In recent offerings, woodworkers like yourselves have saved hundreds of dollars on
many accessories.
Just include your email address on the
order form, call Customer Service, or sign
up online at:
www.shopsmith.com/emailadd.htm
Contacting Shopsmith’s
Service/Technical Support
Have a question about your order – a woodworking question or a problem with a product?
Call our TOLL-FREE Customer Service Hotline at:
1-800-543-7586
Monday – Friday: 9AM – 5PM
Saturday: 9AM – 1PM
A Note About Prices
Although every attempt is made to keep prices
current, at times, changes are necessary.
We reserve the right to adjust prices without
notice and recommend calling to verify a price.
Typographic or photographic errors sometimes
slip through. We reserve the right to correct
these errors when orders are placed.
www.shopsmith.com
Shopsmith’s Factory-Direct Order Form
✁
Fill Out and Fax or Mail with Payment
Method of Payment
Sold To:
Name:______________________________________________________________________________
Address: ____________________________________________________________________________
City:________________________________________ State: _______ Zip: ___________________
Phone: ( _______________ ) __________________________________________________________
❏ FULL PAYMENT
We need your phone number to ensure prompt delivery, and in case a question arises about your order.
❏ BANK CREDIT CARD
Email ______________________________________________________________________________
(Check or money order enclosed)
Personal check, money order or bank draft made payable
to Shopsmith, Inc.
You can use any card listed below (please indicate):
To confirm your shipment. (P.O. Box addresses will ship priority.)
❏ VISA
Ship To: (If different than above)
Name:______________________________________________________________________________
Address: ____________________________________________________________________________
City:________________________________________ State: _______ Zip: ___________________
Phone: ( _______________ ) __________________________________________________________
❏ MasterCard
❏ Discover
❏ American Express
Account/Card Number
Exp. Date (MM/YY)
Authorized Signature: _________________________________________________________________
We need your phone number to ensure prompt delivery, and in case a question arises about your order.
Important Sales Tax Information:
Shipping & Handling Rates
We are required to collect sales tax in Ohio
Within the Continental United States, please add correct amount from the rate chart
shown. Be sure to include additional charges for Truck Ship items as specified. For
other shipping areas, we’ll notify you of estimate cost prior to shipment.
✁
Shipping Information
In stock items will be shipped within 24 business
hours (except weekends). Express shipping
charges are in addition to regular handling
charges. Call before 1PM for Express Service.
Item No.
Qty
Description
Price Each
TOTAL
FEDERAL EXPRESS NEXT DAY
Minimum charge $25 up to 5 pounds
Approx. $1.50 for each additional pound
FEDERAL EXPRESS SECOND DAY
Minimum charge $12.50 up to 5 pounds
Approx. $1.25 for each additional pound
Shipping and Handling Rates
$0.00
– $20.00 ......................$ 6.99
$20.01 – $40.00 ......................$ 8.49
$40.01 – $60.00 ......................$10.99
$60.01 – $80.00 ......................$12.49
$80.01 – $100.00 ....................$14.49
$100.01 – $200.00 ....................$16.49
$200.01 – $350.00 ....................$20.49
$350.01 – $500.00 ....................$23.49
$500.01 and more ..............7% of Total
If your order includes any item with
the copy below, you need to add the
appropriate amount on the order form.
✁
The Shopsmith “Product Name” is a
Special Truck Shipment item and requires
an additional $_____ shipping fee.
This copy indicates a heavier-than-normal
Shopsmith Special Purpose Tool or other heavy
product that will ship Common Carrier Delivery,
and therefore requires a shipping surcharge.
Orders including an item with this wording will
require the additional per item shipping and
handling charge.
1-800-543-7586
Total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
$
Add Shipping Rate from table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . +
Add Appropriate Amount per Truck Ship Item(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . +
Add Local Sales Tax @ __________% . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . +
GRAND TOTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Order Form
$
97
98
www.shopsmith.com